]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blob - gcc/doc/tm.texi.in
linux.h (MD_UNWIND_SUPPORT): Remove.
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi.in
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
2 @c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011
3 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
5 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7 @node Target Macros
8 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
9 @cindex machine description macros
10 @cindex target description macros
11 @cindex macros, target description
12 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
13
14 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
16 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
21 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
22 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
23 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
27
28 @menu
29 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
30 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
31 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
32 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
33 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37 * Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
38 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
39 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
40 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
43 * Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
44 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
45 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
46 * Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
47 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
48 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
49 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
51 * Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
52 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
53 * Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
54 * Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
55 * MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
56 * PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
57 * C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
58 * Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
59 * Misc:: Everything else.
60 @end menu
61
62 @node Target Structure
63 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
64 @cindex target hooks
65 @cindex target functions
66
67 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
69 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
74 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
75 @smallexample
76 #include "target.h"
77 #include "target-def.h"
78
79 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
80
81 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
83
84 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
85 @end smallexample
86 @end deftypevar
87
88 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
89 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
90 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
91 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
92 @code{targetm} structure.
93
94 Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
95 specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
96 Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
97 initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
98 @file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
99 themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
100 @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
101
102 @node Driver
103 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
104 @cindex driver
105 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
106
107 @c prevent bad page break with this line
108 You can control the compilation driver.
109
110 @defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
111 A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
112 initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
113
114 The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
115 default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
116 choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
117 applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
118 options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
119 using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
120
121 This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
122 options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
123 that the other specs are easier to write.
124
125 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
126 @end defmac
127
128 @defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
129 A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
130 @option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
131 for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
132 outermost pair of surrounding braces.
133
134 The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
135 the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
136 to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
137 @samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
138 everywhere it occurs.
139
140 The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
141 default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
142 the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
143
144 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
145 @end defmac
146
147 @defmac CPP_SPEC
148 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
149 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
150 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
151
152 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
153 @end defmac
154
155 @defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
156 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
157 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
158 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
159 @end defmac
160
161 @defmac CC1_SPEC
162 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
163 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
164 front ends.
165 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
166 for GCC to pass to front ends.
167
168 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
169 @end defmac
170
171 @defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
172 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
173 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
174 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
175
176 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
177 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
178 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
179 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
180 @end defmac
181
182 @defmac ASM_SPEC
183 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
184 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
185 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
186 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
187
188 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
189 @end defmac
190
191 @defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
192 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
193 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
194 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
195 an example of this.
196
197 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
198 @end defmac
199
200 @defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
201 Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
202 an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
203 read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
204 output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
205 @option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
206
207 If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
208 standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
209 cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
210 see @file{mips.h} for instance.
211 @end defmac
212
213 @defmac LINK_SPEC
214 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
215 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
216 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
217
218 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
219 @end defmac
220
221 @defmac LIB_SPEC
222 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
223 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
224 command given to the linker.
225
226 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
227 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
228 @end defmac
229
230 @defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
231 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
232 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
233 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
234 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
235
236 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
237 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
238 @end defmac
239
240 @defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
241 By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
242 @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
243 instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
244 depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
245 @option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
246 targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
247 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
248 driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
249 line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
250 @end defmac
251
252 @defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
253 A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
254 mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
255 generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
256 static exception handler library, when linking without any of
257 @code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
258 @end defmac
259
260 @defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
261 If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
262 When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
263 the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
264 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
265 @end defmac
266
267 @defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
268 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
269 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
270 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
271
272 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
273 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
274 @end defmac
275
276 @defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
277 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
278 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
279 the very end of the command given to the linker.
280
281 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
282 @end defmac
283
284 @defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
285 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
286 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
287 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
288 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
289 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
290 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
291 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
292 @end defmac
293
294 @defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
295 Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
296 configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
297 et al, within sysroot+suffix.
298 @end defmac
299
300 @defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
301 Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
302 GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
303 updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
304 usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
305 @end defmac
306
307 @defmac EXTRA_SPECS
308 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
309 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
310 @code{CC1_SPEC}.
311
312 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
313 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
314 string constant that provides the specification.
315
316 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
317
318 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
319 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
320 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
321 these definitions.
322
323 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
324 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
325 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
326 used.
327
328 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
329
330 @smallexample
331 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
332 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
333
334 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
335 @end smallexample
336
337 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
338 @smallexample
339 #undef CPP_SPEC
340 #define CPP_SPEC \
341 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
342 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
343 %@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
344 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
345
346 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
347 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
348 @end smallexample
349
350 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
351 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
352
353 @smallexample
354 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
355 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
356 @end smallexample
357 @end defmac
358
359 @defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
360 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
361 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
362 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
363 @end defmac
364
365 @defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
366 The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
367 By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
368 @end defmac
369
370 @defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
371 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
372 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
373 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
374 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
375 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
376 the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
377 @code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
378 @end defmac
379
380 @defmac LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
381 A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
382 directories from linking commands. Do not give it a nonzero value if
383 removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
384 @end defmac
385
386 @defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
387 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
388 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
389 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
390 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
391
392 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
393 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
394 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
395 @xref{Target Fragment}.
396 @end defmac
397
398 @defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
399 Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
400 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
401 indicates an absolute file name.
402 @end defmac
403
404 @defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
405 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
406 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
407 when the compiler is built as a cross
408 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
409 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
410 @end defmac
411
412 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
413 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
414 standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
415 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
416 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
417 is built as a cross compiler.
418 @end defmac
419
420 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
421 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
422 standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
423 when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
424 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
425 is built as a cross compiler.
426 @end defmac
427
428 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
429 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
430 standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
431 default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
432 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
433 is built as a cross compiler.
434 @end defmac
435
436 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
437 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
438 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
439 compiler is built as a cross compiler.
440 @end defmac
441
442 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
443 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
444 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
445 cross compiler.
446 @end defmac
447
448 @defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
449 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
450 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
451 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
452 initialize the necessary environment variables.
453 @end defmac
454
455 @defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
456 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
457 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
458 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
459 comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
460
461 Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
462 replacement.
463 @end defmac
464
465 @defmac SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
466 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
467 system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
468 directory. @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
469 @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
470
471 Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
472 specified.
473 @end defmac
474
475 @defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
476 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
477 standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
478 try when searching for header files.
479
480 Cross compilers ignore this macro and do not search either
481 @file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
482 @end defmac
483
484 @defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
485 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
486 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
487 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
488 @end defmac
489
490 @defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
491 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
492 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
493 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
494 @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
495 @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
496 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
497 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
498 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
499
500 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
501 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
502 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
503 for C++-only directories,
504 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
505 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
506 the array with a null element.
507
508 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
509 if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
510 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
511 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
512
513 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
514
515 @smallexample
516 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
517 @{ \
518 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
519 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
520 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
521 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
522 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
523 @}
524 @end smallexample
525 @end defmac
526
527 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
528
529 @enumerate
530 @item
531 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
532
533 @item
534 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
535 is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
536 @var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
537
538 @item
539 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
540
541 @item
542 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
543 in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
544
545 @item
546 The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
547
548 @item
549 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
550
551 @item
552 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
553 compiler.
554 @end enumerate
555
556 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
557
558 @enumerate
559 @item
560 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
561
562 @item
563 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
564 value based on the installed toolchain location.
565
566 @item
567 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
568 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
569
570 @item
571 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
572 in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
573
574 @item
575 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
576
577 @item
578 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
579 compiler.
580
581 @item
582 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
583 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
584
585 @item
586 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
587 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
588
589 @item
590 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
591 If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
592 the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
593
594 @item
595 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
596 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
597 @file{/lib/}.
598
599 @item
600 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
601 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
602 @file{/usr/lib/}.
603 @end enumerate
604
605 @node Run-time Target
606 @section Run-time Target Specification
607 @cindex run-time target specification
608 @cindex predefined macros
609 @cindex target specifications
610
611 @c prevent bad page break with this line
612 Here are run-time target specifications.
613
614 @defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
615 This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
616 built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
617 the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
618 @code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
619 calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
620 finished command line option processing your code can use those
621 results freely.
622
623 @code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
624 command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
625 the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
626 accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
627
628 @code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
629 object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
630 @code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
631 defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
632 with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
633 only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
634 example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
635 and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
636 @code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
637 defines only @code{_ABI64}.
638
639 You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
640 @code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
641 or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
642 assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
643 macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
644 to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
645 variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
646 @code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
647 preprocessing.
648 @end defmac
649
650 @defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
651 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
652 and is used for the target operating system instead.
653 @end defmac
654
655 @defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
656 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
657 and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
658 macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
659 it yourself.
660 @end defmac
661
662 @deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
663 This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
664 any target-specific headers.
665 @end deftypevar
666
667 @hook TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
668 This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
669 Its default setting is 0.
670 @end deftypevr
671
672 @cindex optional hardware or system features
673 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
674
675 @hook TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION
676 This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
677 target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
678 (@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
679 processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
680 definition does nothing but return true.
681
682 @var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
683 @var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
684 storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
685 option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
686 via attributes).
687 @end deftypefn
688
689 @hook TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION
690 This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
691 target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
692 definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
693 option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
694 valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
695 default definition does nothing but return false.
696
697 In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
698 options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
699 only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
700 should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
701 @end deftypefn
702
703 @hook TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT
704
705 @hook TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P
706
707 @hook TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG
708
709 @hook TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE
710 This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
711 but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
712 pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
713 attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
714 when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
715 actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
716 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
717 @end deftypefn
718
719 @defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
720 This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
721 but is only used in the C
722 language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
723 used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
724 frontends.
725 @end defmac
726
727 @hook TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
728 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
729 various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
730 options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
731 options are processed once
732 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
733 of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
734 options passed explicitly.
735
736 This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
737 options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
738 @code{optimize} attribute.
739 @end deftypevr
740
741 @hook TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT
742
743 @hook TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS
744
745 @hook TARGET_HELP
746 This hook is called in response to the user invoking
747 @option{--target-help} on the command line. It gives the target a
748 chance to display extra information on the target specific command
749 line options found in its @file{.opt} file.
750 @end deftypefn
751
752 @defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
753 Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
754 during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
755 the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
756 can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
757 and @code{nomips16} attributes.
758
759 Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
760 registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
761 operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
762 in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
763 significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
764 for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
765 switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
766
767 Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
768 is 0.
769 @end defmac
770
771 @node Per-Function Data
772 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
773 @cindex per-function data
774 @cindex data structures
775
776 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
777 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
778 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
779 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
780 when another one comes along.
781
782 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
783 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
784 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
785 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
786 to their own specific data.
787
788 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
789 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
790 This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
791 @code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
792
793 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
794 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
795 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
796 function, for level 0.
797
798 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
799 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
800 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
801 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
802 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
803 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
804 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
805 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
806 longer supported.
807
808 @defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
809 Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
810 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
811 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
812 function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
813 @end defmac
814
815 @deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
816 If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
817 function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
818 target to perform any target specific initialization of the
819 @code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
820 used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
821
822 @code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
823 Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
824 GC allocation, including the structure itself.
825 @end deftypevar
826
827 @node Storage Layout
828 @section Storage Layout
829 @cindex storage layout
830
831 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
832 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
833 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
834 @xref{Run-time Target}.
835
836 @defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
837 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
838 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
839 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
840 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
841 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
842 macro need not be a constant.
843
844 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
845 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
846 @end defmac
847
848 @defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
849 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
850 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
851 @end defmac
852
853 @defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
854 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
855 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
856 memory locations and registers; GCC fundamentally assumes that the
857 order of words in memory is the same as the order in registers. This
858 macro need not be a constant.
859 @end defmac
860
861 @defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
862 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
863 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
864 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
865 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
866
867 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
868 multi-word integers.
869 @end defmac
870
871 @defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
872 Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
873 unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
874 @end defmac
875
876 @defmac BITS_PER_WORD
877 Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
878 is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
879 @end defmac
880
881 @defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
882 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
883 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
884 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
885 @end defmac
886
887 @defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
888 Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
889 register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
890 @end defmac
891
892 @defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
893 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
894 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
895 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
896 @end defmac
897
898 @defmac POINTER_SIZE
899 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
900 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
901 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
902 a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
903 @end defmac
904
905 @defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
906 A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
907 @code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
908 greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
909 should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
910 is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
911 @code{ptr_extend} instruction.
912
913 You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
914 and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
915 @end defmac
916
917 @defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
918 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
919 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
920 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
921 scalar type.
922
923 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
924 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
925 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
926 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
927 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
928 counterparts.
929
930 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
931 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
932 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
933 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
934 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
935 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
936
937 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
938 @end defmac
939
940 @hook TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE
941 Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
942 function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
943 and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
944 change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
945 pointer} types.
946
947 @var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
948 return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
949 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
950 If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
951 which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
952 then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
953 the signedness may be different.
954
955 @var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
956
957 The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
958 also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
959 if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
960 @end deftypefn
961
962 @defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
963 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
964 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
965 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
966 size of an integer.
967 @end defmac
968
969 @defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
970 Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
971 stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
972 desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
973 if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
974 this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
975 @end defmac
976
977 @defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
978 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
979 stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
980 is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
981 macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
982 @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
983 @end defmac
984
985 @defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
986 Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
987 from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
988 to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
989 @end defmac
990
991 @defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
992 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
993 @end defmac
994
995 @defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
996 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
997 bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
998 just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
999 @end defmac
1000
1001 @defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1002 Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1003 provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1004 @end defmac
1005
1006 @defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1007 Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1008 not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1009 @end defmac
1010
1011 @defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1012 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1013 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1014 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1015 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1016 @end defmac
1017
1018 @defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1019 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1020 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1021 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1022 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1023 @end defmac
1024
1025 @defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1026 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1027 alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1028 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1029 alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1030 field alignment has not been set by the
1031 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1032 @end defmac
1033
1034 @defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1035 Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1036 to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1037
1038 If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1039
1040 @c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1041 @c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1042 @c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1043 @c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1044 @end defmac
1045
1046 @defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1047 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1048 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1049 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1050 the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1051
1052 On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1053 the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1054 a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1055 On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1056 @samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1057 @end defmac
1058
1059 @defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1060 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1061 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1062 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1063 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1064
1065 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1066
1067 @findex strcpy
1068 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1069 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1070 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1071 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1072 @end defmac
1073
1074 @defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1075 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1076 that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1077 @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1078 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1079 align the object.
1080
1081 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1082
1083 The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1084 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1085 constants can be done inline.
1086 @end defmac
1087
1088 @defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1089 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1090 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1091 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1092 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1093
1094 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1095
1096 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1097 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1098
1099 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1100 @end defmac
1101
1102 @defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1103 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1104 @var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1105 and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1106 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1107 align the slot.
1108
1109 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1110 @var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1111 be used.
1112
1113 This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1114 of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1115
1116 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1117 @end defmac
1118
1119 @defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1120 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1121 variable @var{decl}.
1122
1123 If this macro is not defined, then
1124 @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1125 is used.
1126
1127 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1128 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1129
1130 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1131 @end defmac
1132
1133 @defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1134 If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1135 for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1136 @var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1137
1138 If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1139 @end defmac
1140
1141 @defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1142 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1143 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1144
1145 If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1146 @end defmac
1147
1148 @defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1149 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1150 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1151
1152 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1153 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1154 @end defmac
1155
1156 @defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1157 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1158 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1159 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1160 @end defmac
1161
1162 @defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1163 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1164 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1165
1166 The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1167 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1168 structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1169 that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1170 that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1171
1172 Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1173 @code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1174 four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1175 not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1176
1177 An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1178 structure.
1179
1180 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1181 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1182
1183 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1184 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1185 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1186 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1187
1188 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1189 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1190 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1191
1192 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1193 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1194 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1195
1196 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1197 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1198 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1199
1200 @smallexample
1201 struct foo1
1202 @{
1203 char x;
1204 char :0;
1205 char y;
1206 @};
1207
1208 struct foo2
1209 @{
1210 char x;
1211 int :0;
1212 char y;
1213 @};
1214
1215 main ()
1216 @{
1217 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1218 sizeof (struct foo1));
1219 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1220 sizeof (struct foo2));
1221 exit (0);
1222 @}
1223 @end smallexample
1224
1225 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1226 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1227 @end defmac
1228
1229 @defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1230 Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1231 to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1232 @end defmac
1233
1234 @hook TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD
1235 When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1236 whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1237 structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1238 the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1239 @end deftypefn
1240
1241 @hook TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD
1242 This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1243 should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1244 these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1245
1246 The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1247 @end deftypefn
1248
1249 @defmac MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
1250 Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1251 @code{BLKMODE}.
1252
1253 If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1254 mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1255 case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1256 retain the field's mode.
1257
1258 Normally, this is not needed.
1259 @end defmac
1260
1261 @defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1262 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1263 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1264 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1265 @var{specified}.
1266
1267 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1268 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1269 @end defmac
1270
1271 @defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1272 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1273 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1274 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1275 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1276 (DImode)} is assumed.
1277 @end defmac
1278
1279 @defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1280 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1281 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1282 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1283 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1284 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1285 having its mode specified.
1286
1287 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1288 would most commonly define this macro if the
1289 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1290 64-bit mode.
1291 @end defmac
1292
1293 @defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1294 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1295 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1296 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1297
1298 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1299 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1300 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1301 @end defmac
1302
1303 @hook TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE
1304 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1305 of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1306 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1307 targets.
1308 @end deftypefn
1309
1310 @hook TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE
1311 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1312 of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1313 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1314 targets.
1315 @end deftypefn
1316
1317 @hook TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE
1318 Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1319 The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1320 @end deftypefn
1321
1322 @defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1323 If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1324 mode is towards zero.
1325
1326 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1327 floating-point arithmetic.
1328
1329 Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1330 @end defmac
1331
1332 @defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1333 This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1334 bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1335 exponent for normal numbers instead.
1336
1337 Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1338 floating-point arithmetic.
1339
1340 The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1341 @end defmac
1342
1343 @hook TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P
1344 This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1345 @var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1346 Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1347 unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1348 different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1349 alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1350 bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1351 the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1352 (iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1353 another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1354 other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1355
1356 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1357 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1358 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1359 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1360 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1361 size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1362 alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1363
1364 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1365 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1366 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1367 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1368 may affect its placement.
1369 @end deftypefn
1370
1371 @hook TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P
1372 Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1373 @end deftypefn
1374
1375 @hook TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P
1376 Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1377 @end deftypefn
1378
1379 @hook TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK
1380 This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1381 to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1382 For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1383 for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1384 registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1385 usage.
1386 @end deftypefn
1387
1388 @hook TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS
1389 This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1390 that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1391 @end deftypefn
1392
1393 @hook TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE
1394 If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1395 uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1396 to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1397 mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1398 the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1399 not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1400 for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1401 return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1402 string constant.
1403
1404 Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1405 qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1406 fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1407 is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1408 length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1409 ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1410 @var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1411 @var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1412 code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1413 @code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1414 codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1415 spaces in your string.
1416
1417 This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1418 name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1419 can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1420 before mangling.
1421
1422 The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1423 appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1424 types.
1425 @end deftypefn
1426
1427 @node Type Layout
1428 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1429
1430 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1431 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1432 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1433 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1434
1435 @defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1436 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1437 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1438 @end defmac
1439
1440 @defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1441 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1442 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1443 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1444 unit.)
1445 @end defmac
1446
1447 @defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1448 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1449 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1450 @end defmac
1451
1452 @defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1453 On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1454 @code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1455 that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1456 the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1457 value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1458 @end defmac
1459
1460 @defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1461 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1462 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1463 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1464 macro must be at least 64.
1465 @end defmac
1466
1467 @defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1468 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1469 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1470 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1471 @end defmac
1472
1473 @defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1474 A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1475 C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1476 this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1477 @end defmac
1478
1479 @defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1480 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1481 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1482 @end defmac
1483
1484 @defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1485 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1486 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1487 words.
1488 @end defmac
1489
1490 @defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1491 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1492 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1493 words.
1494 @end defmac
1495
1496 @defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1497 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1498 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1499 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1500 @end defmac
1501
1502 @defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1503 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1504 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1505 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1506 @end defmac
1507
1508 @defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1509 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1510 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1511 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1512 @end defmac
1513
1514 @defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1515 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1516 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1517 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1518 @end defmac
1519
1520 @defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1521 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1522 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1523 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1524 @end defmac
1525
1526 @defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1527 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1528 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1529 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1530 @end defmac
1531
1532 @defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1533 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1534 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1535 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1536 @end defmac
1537
1538 @defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1539 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1540 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1541 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1542 @end defmac
1543
1544 @defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1545 Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1546 if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1547 @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1548 default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1549 @end defmac
1550
1551 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
1552 Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
1553 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1554 @code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1555 anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1556 or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1557 otherwise it is 0.
1558 @end defmac
1559
1560 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1561 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1562 @code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1563 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1564 is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1565 @end defmac
1566
1567 @defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1568 Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1569 @code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1570 anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1571 is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1572 @end defmac
1573
1574 @defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1575 This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1576 hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1577 causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1578 prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1579 uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1580 the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1581 @end defmac
1582
1583 @defmac SF_SIZE
1584 @defmacx DF_SIZE
1585 @defmacx XF_SIZE
1586 @defmacx TF_SIZE
1587 Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1588 @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1589 if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1590 @code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1591 for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1592 @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
1593 @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
1594 @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1595 @end defmac
1596
1597 @defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1598 A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1599 assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1600 default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1601 @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1602 @end defmac
1603
1604 @defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1605 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1606 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1607 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1608 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1609 is the default.
1610 @end defmac
1611
1612 @defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1613 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1614 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1615 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1616 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1617 @end defmac
1618
1619 @hook TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1620 This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1621 @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1622 of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1623 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1624
1625 The default is to return false.
1626 @end deftypefn
1627
1628 @defmac SIZE_TYPE
1629 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1630 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1631 contents of the string.
1632
1633 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1634 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1635 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1636 of the data type names defined in the function
1637 @code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}. You may not
1638 omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1639 crash on startup.
1640
1641 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1642 int"}.
1643 @end defmac
1644
1645 @defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1646 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1647 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1648 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1649 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1650
1651 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1652 @end defmac
1653
1654 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1655 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1656 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1657 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1658 information.
1659
1660 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1661 @end defmac
1662
1663 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1664 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1665 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1666 @code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1667 @end defmac
1668
1669 @defmac WINT_TYPE
1670 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1671 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1672 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1673 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1674 information.
1675
1676 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1677 @end defmac
1678
1679 @defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1680 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1681 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1682 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1683 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1684
1685 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1686 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1687 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1688 @end defmac
1689
1690 @defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1691 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1692 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1693 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1694 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1695
1696 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1697 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1698 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1699 int}.
1700 @end defmac
1701
1702 @defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1703 @defmacx INT8_TYPE
1704 @defmacx INT16_TYPE
1705 @defmacx INT32_TYPE
1706 @defmacx INT64_TYPE
1707 @defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1708 @defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1709 @defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1710 @defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1711 @defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1712 @defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1713 @defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1714 @defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1715 @defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1716 @defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1717 @defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1718 @defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1719 @defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1720 @defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1721 @defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1722 @defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1723 @defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1724 @defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1725 @defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1726 @defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1727 @defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1728 @defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1729 C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1730 @code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1731 @code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1732 @code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1733 @code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1734 @code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1735 @code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1736 @code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1737 @code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1738 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1739
1740 If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1741 type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1742 @code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1743 to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1744 these macros are null pointers.
1745 @end defmac
1746
1747 @defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1748 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1749 that looks like:
1750
1751 @smallexample
1752 struct @{
1753 union @{
1754 void (*fn)();
1755 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1756 @};
1757 ptrdiff_t delta;
1758 @};
1759 @end smallexample
1760
1761 @noindent
1762 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1763 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1764 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1765 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1766 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1767 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1768 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1769 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1770
1771 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1772 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1773 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1774 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1775 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1776 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1777 architecture, you should define this macro to
1778 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1779
1780 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1781 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1782 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1783 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1784 @end defmac
1785
1786 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1787 Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1788 macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1789 instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1790 function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1791 data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1792 pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1793
1794 If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1795 of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1796 @end defmac
1797
1798 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1799 By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1800 is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1801 the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1802 when special alignment is necessary. */
1803 @end defmac
1804
1805 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1806 There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1807 zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1808 specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1809 of words in each data entry.
1810 @end defmac
1811
1812 @node Registers
1813 @section Register Usage
1814 @cindex register usage
1815
1816 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1817 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1818
1819 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1820 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1821 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1822 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1823 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1824
1825 @menu
1826 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1827 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1828 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1829 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1830 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1831 @end menu
1832
1833 @node Register Basics
1834 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1835
1836 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1837 Registers have various characteristics.
1838
1839 @defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1840 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1841 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1842 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1843 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1844 @end defmac
1845
1846 @defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1847 @cindex fixed register
1848 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1849 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1850 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1851 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1852 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1853 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1854 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1855
1856 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1857 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1858 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1859
1860 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1861 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1862 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1863 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1864 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1865 @end defmac
1866
1867 @defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1868 @cindex call-used register
1869 @cindex call-clobbered register
1870 @cindex call-saved register
1871 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1872 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1873 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1874 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1875 function calls.
1876
1877 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1878 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1879 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1880 @end defmac
1881
1882 @defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1883 @cindex call-used register
1884 @cindex call-clobbered register
1885 @cindex call-saved register
1886 Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1887 that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1888 (@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1889 This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1890 of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1891 @end defmac
1892
1893 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1894 @cindex call-used register
1895 @cindex call-clobbered register
1896 @cindex call-saved register
1897 A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1898 value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1899 call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1900 macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1901 preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1902 @end defmac
1903
1904 @findex fixed_regs
1905 @findex call_used_regs
1906 @findex global_regs
1907 @findex reg_names
1908 @findex reg_class_contents
1909 @hook TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1910 This hook may conditionally modify five variables
1911 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1912 @code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1913 any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1914 of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1915 @code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1916 @code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1917 called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1918 @code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1919 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1920 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1921 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1922 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1923 command options have been applied.
1924
1925 @cindex disabling certain registers
1926 @cindex controlling register usage
1927 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1928 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1929 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1930 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
1931 the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1932 to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1933 is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1934
1935 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1936 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1937 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1938 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1939 @end deftypefn
1940
1941 @defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1942 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1943 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1944 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1945 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1946 outbound register.
1947 @end defmac
1948
1949 @defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1950 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1951 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1952 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1953 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1954 register.
1955 @end defmac
1956
1957 @defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1958 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1959 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1960 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1961 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1962 gotos.
1963 @end defmac
1964
1965 @defmac PC_REGNUM
1966 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1967 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1968 @end defmac
1969
1970 @node Allocation Order
1971 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1972 @cindex order of register allocation
1973 @cindex register allocation order
1974
1975 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1976 Registers are allocated in order.
1977
1978 @defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1979 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1980 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1981 to use them (from most preferred to least).
1982
1983 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1984 (all else being equal).
1985
1986 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1987 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1988 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1989 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1990 the highest numbered allocable register first.
1991 @end defmac
1992
1993 @defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1994 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1995 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1996
1997 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1998 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1999 register; and so on.
2000
2001 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2002 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2003
2004 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2005 @end defmac
2006
2007 @defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2008 Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2009 prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2010 using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2011 allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2012 call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2013 should be defined.
2014 @end defmac
2015
2016 @defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2017 In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2018 Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2019 If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2020 based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2021 be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2022 value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2023 to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2024
2025 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2026 @end defmac
2027
2028 @node Values in Registers
2029 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2030
2031 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2032 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2033 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2034
2035 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2036 A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2037 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2038 @var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2039 cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2040 and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2041
2042 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2043 definition of this macro is
2044
2045 @smallexample
2046 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2047 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2048 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2049 @end smallexample
2050 @end defmac
2051
2052 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2053 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2054 in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2055 in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2056 multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2057 this mode by the number of registers returned by
2058 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2059
2060 For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2061 registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2062 nonzero.
2063
2064 This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2065 @code{subreg_get_info}
2066 would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2067 represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2068 @code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2069 registers and so not be representable.
2070 @end defmac
2071
2072 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2073 For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2074 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2075 returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2076 including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2077 @end defmac
2078
2079 @defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2080 Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2081 of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2082 should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2083 used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2084 happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2085 floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2086 @end defmac
2087
2088 @defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2089 A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2090 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2091 registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2092 are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2093
2094 @smallexample
2095 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2096 @end smallexample
2097
2098 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2099 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2100
2101 @cindex register pairs
2102 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2103 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2104 odd register numbers for such modes.
2105
2106 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2107 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2108 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2109 value into the register and back out not alter it.
2110
2111 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2112 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2113 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2114 you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2115 is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2116 and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2117 to be tieable.
2118
2119 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2120 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2121 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2122 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2123 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2124 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2125
2126 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2127 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2128 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2129 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2130 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2131 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2132 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2133 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2134 register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2135
2136 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2137 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2138 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2139 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2140 constraints for those instructions.
2141
2142 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2143 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2144 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2145 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2146 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2147 @end defmac
2148
2149 @defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2150 A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2151 @var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2152
2153 One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2154 another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2155 handler.
2156
2157 The default is always nonzero.
2158 @end defmac
2159
2160 @defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2161 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2162 @var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2163
2164 If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2165 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2166 any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2167 should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2168 this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2169 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2170
2171 You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2172 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2173 allocation.
2174 @end defmac
2175
2176 @hook TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK
2177 This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2178 @var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2179
2180 One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2181 is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2182
2183 The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2184 @end deftypefn
2185
2186 @defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2187 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2188 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2189 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2190 @end defmac
2191
2192 @node Leaf Functions
2193 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2194
2195 @cindex leaf functions
2196 @cindex functions, leaf
2197 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2198 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2199 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2200 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2201 normally arrive.
2202
2203 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2204 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2205 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2206 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2207 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2208 functions''.
2209
2210 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2211 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2212 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2213 accomplish this.
2214
2215 @defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2216 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2217 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2218 function treatment.
2219
2220 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2221 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2222 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2223 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2224 in this vector.
2225
2226 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2227 the treatment of leaf functions.
2228 @end defmac
2229
2230 @defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2231 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2232 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2233
2234 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2235 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2236 will cause the compiler to abort.
2237
2238 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2239 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2240 this.
2241 @end defmac
2242
2243 @findex current_function_is_leaf
2244 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2245 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2246 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2247 specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2248 which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2249 set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2250 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2251 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2252 functions which only use leaf registers.
2253 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2254 that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2255 @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2256 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2257 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2258
2259 @node Stack Registers
2260 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2261
2262 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2263 ``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2264 pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2265 stack.
2266
2267 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2268 they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2269 support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2270 point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2271 stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2272 @file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2273 with it, as well as defining these macros.
2274
2275 @defmac STACK_REGS
2276 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2277 @end defmac
2278
2279 @defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2280 This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2281 the machine has any stack-like registers.
2282 @end defmac
2283
2284 @defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2285 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2286 of the stack.
2287 @end defmac
2288
2289 @defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2290 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2291 the stack.
2292 @end defmac
2293
2294 @node Register Classes
2295 @section Register Classes
2296 @cindex register class definitions
2297 @cindex class definitions, register
2298
2299 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2300 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2301 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2302 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2303
2304 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2305 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2306 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2307
2308 @findex ALL_REGS
2309 @findex NO_REGS
2310 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2311 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2312 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2313 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2314
2315 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2316 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2317 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2318 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2319 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2320 to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2321
2322 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2323 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2324
2325 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2326 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2327 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2328 them in operand constraints.
2329
2330 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2331 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2332 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2333 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2334 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2335 or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
2336 class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
2337
2338 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2339 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2340 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2341 in their union.
2342
2343 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2344 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2345 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2346 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2347 specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2348
2349 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2350 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2351 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2352 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2353 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2354 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2355 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2356 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2357 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2358
2359 @deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2360 An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2361 as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2362 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2363 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2364 tells how many classes there are.
2365
2366 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2367 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2368 in many of the tables described below.
2369 @end deftp
2370
2371 @defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2372 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2373
2374 @smallexample
2375 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2376 @end smallexample
2377 @end defmac
2378
2379 @defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2380 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2381 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2382 @end defmac
2383
2384 @defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2385 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2386 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2387 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2388 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2389
2390 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2391 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2392 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2393 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2394 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2395 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2396 so on.
2397 @end defmac
2398
2399 @defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2400 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2401 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2402 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2403 register.
2404 @end defmac
2405
2406 @defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2407 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2408 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2409 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2410 @end defmac
2411
2412 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2413 This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2414 the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2415 @var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2416 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2417 @end defmac
2418
2419 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2420 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2421 base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2422 register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2423 addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2424 @end defmac
2425
2426 @defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2427 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2428 base register must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code} define the
2429 context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is the code of
2430 the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level of an
2431 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2432 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2433 index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2434 @end defmac
2435
2436 @defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2437 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2438 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2439 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2440 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2441 @end defmac
2442
2443 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2444 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2445 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2446 @end defmac
2447
2448 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2449 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2450 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2451 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2452 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2453 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2454 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2455 addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2456 @code{address_operand}.
2457 @end defmac
2458
2459 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2460 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2461 use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2462 memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2463 pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2464 define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2465 than other base register uses.
2466
2467 Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2468 @code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2469 @end defmac
2470
2471 @defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2472 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2473 that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2474 appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2475 immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2476 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2477 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2478 corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2479 @code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2480 that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2481 @end defmac
2482
2483 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2484 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2485 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2486 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2487 allocated such a hard register.
2488
2489 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2490 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2491 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2492 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2493 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2494 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2495 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2496 only if neither labeling works.
2497 @end defmac
2498
2499 @hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS
2500
2501 @hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS
2502 A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2503 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2504 @var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2505 another, smaller class.
2506
2507 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2508
2509 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2510 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2511 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2512 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2513 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2514
2515 One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2516 @var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2517 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2518 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2519 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2520 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2521 register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2522 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2523 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2524 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2525 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2526
2527 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2528 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2529 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2530 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2531 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2532 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2533 @end deftypefn
2534
2535 @defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2536 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2537 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2538 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2539 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2540 safe:
2541
2542 @smallexample
2543 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2544 @end smallexample
2545
2546 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2547 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2548 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2549 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2550 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2551
2552 One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2553 @var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2554 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2555 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2556 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2557 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2558 register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2559 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2560 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2561 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2562 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2563
2564 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2565 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2566 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2567 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2568 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2569 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2570 @end defmac
2571
2572 @defmac PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2573 Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2574 input reloads. If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
2575 @var{class}, unchanged.
2576
2577 You can also use @code{PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2578 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2579 @end defmac
2580
2581 @hook TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2582 Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2583 input reloads.
2584
2585 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2586 argument.
2587
2588 You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2589 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2590 @end deftypefn
2591
2592 @defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2593 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2594 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2595 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2596 ordinarily be used.
2597
2598 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2599 there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2600
2601 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2602 smaller class.
2603
2604 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2605 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2606 @end defmac
2607
2608 @hook TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD
2609 Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2610 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2611 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2612 from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2613 term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2614 directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2615 register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2616 destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2617 source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2618 reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2619 and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2620 intermediate register still holds the required value.
2621
2622 Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2623 allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2624 register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2625 address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2626 when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2627 as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2628 that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2629 describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2630 these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2631 of the scratch register(s).
2632
2633 In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2634
2635 For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2636 and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2637 @var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2638 hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2639 needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2640
2641 If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2642 an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2643 return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2644 If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2645 If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2646 that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2647
2648 If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2649 perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2650 closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2651 required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2652 copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2653
2654 You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2655 in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2656 and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2657 for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2658 single-register-class
2659 @c [later: or memory]
2660 output constraint.
2661
2662 When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2663 hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2664 register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2665 have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2666
2667 @c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2668 @c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2669 @c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2670 @c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2671 @c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2672 @c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2673 @c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2674 @c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2675
2676
2677 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2678 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2679 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2680 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2681
2682 Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2683 currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2684 to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2685
2686 @code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2687 copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2688 (a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2689 Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2690 of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2691 forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2692 @end deftypefn
2693
2694 @defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2695 @defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2696 @defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2697 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2698 @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2699
2700 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2701 target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2702 reload phase that it may
2703 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2704 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2705 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2706 you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2707 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2708 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2709
2710 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2711 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2712 was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2713 class required. If the
2714 requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2715 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2716 macros identically.
2717
2718 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2719 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2720 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2721 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2722 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2723
2724 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2725 intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2726 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2727 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2728 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2729 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2730 register.
2731
2732 These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2733 register that
2734 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2735 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2736 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2737 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2738 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2739
2740 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2741 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2742 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2743 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2744
2745 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2746 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2747 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2748 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2749 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2750 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2751 general registers.
2752 @end defmac
2753
2754 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2755 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2756 to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2757 those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2758 @var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2759 class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2760 and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2761
2762 Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2763 @end defmac
2764
2765 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2766 Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2767 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2768 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2769 defined by this macro.
2770
2771 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2772 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2773 @end defmac
2774
2775 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2776 When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2777 registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2778 hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2779 load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2780 same as that of @var{mode}.
2781
2782 This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2783 bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2784 in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2785 registers.
2786
2787 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2788 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2789 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2790 widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2791 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2792 details.
2793
2794 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2795 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2796 is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2797 @end defmac
2798
2799 @hook TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
2800 A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2801 to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2802 registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2803
2804 The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2805 has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2806 default should be used. Only use this target hook to some other expression
2807 if pseudos allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their
2808 hard registers were needed for spill registers. If this target hook returns
2809 @code{false} for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2810 @file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2811 register. If there would not be another register available for reallocation,
2812 you should not change the implementation of this target hook since
2813 the only effect of such implementation would be to slow down register
2814 allocation.
2815 @end deftypefn
2816
2817 @defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2818 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2819 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2820
2821 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2822 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2823 should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2824 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2825
2826 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2827 in the reload pass.
2828 @end defmac
2829
2830 @defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2831 If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2832 a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2833
2834 For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2835 floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2836 Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2837 does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2838 register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2839 as below:
2840
2841 @smallexample
2842 #define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2843 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2844 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2845 @end smallexample
2846 @end defmac
2847
2848 @node Old Constraints
2849 @section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2850 @cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2851 @cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2852
2853 Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2854 of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2855 Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2856 it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2857
2858 @defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2859 For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2860 @var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2861 constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2862 you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2863 constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2864 DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2865 to handle specially.
2866 There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2867 for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2868 transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2869 return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2870 will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2871 @end defmac
2872
2873 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2874 A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2875 letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2876 value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2877 the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2878 corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2879 to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2880 @end defmac
2881
2882 @defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2883 Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2884 passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2885 different variants.
2886 @end defmac
2887
2888 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2889 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2890 letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2891 particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2892 letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2893 the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2894 not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2895 @var{value}.
2896 @end defmac
2897
2898 @defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2899 Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2900 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2901 between different variants.
2902 @end defmac
2903
2904 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2905 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2906 letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2907 (@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2908
2909 If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2910 @var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2911 range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2912 letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2913
2914 @code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2915 @code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2916 or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2917 between these kinds.
2918 @end defmac
2919
2920 @defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2921 Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2922 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2923 between different variants.
2924 @end defmac
2925
2926 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2927 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2928 letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2929 memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
2930 elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2931 @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2932 may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
2933
2934 If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2935 if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2936 constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2937 constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2938
2939 For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2940 in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
2941 letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2942 @emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
2943 a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
2944 alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2945 does not include r0 on the output.
2946 @end defmac
2947
2948 @defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2949 Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
2950 in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
2951 variants.
2952 @end defmac
2953
2954 @defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2955 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2956 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
2957 be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
2958
2959 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2960 at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
2961 comprises a subset of all memory references including
2962 all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
2963 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2964 type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
2965
2966 For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
2967 memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
2968 register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
2969 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
2970 If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
2971 a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
2972 reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
2973 into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
2974 an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
2975 @end defmac
2976
2977 @defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2978 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2979 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
2980 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
2981 be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
2982
2983 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2984 at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
2985 a subset of all memory addresses including
2986 all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
2987 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2988 type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
2989
2990 Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
2991 be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
2992 analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
2993 @end defmac
2994
2995 @node Stack and Calling
2996 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
2997 @cindex calling conventions
2998
2999 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3000 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3001
3002 @menu
3003 * Frame Layout::
3004 * Exception Handling::
3005 * Stack Checking::
3006 * Frame Registers::
3007 * Elimination::
3008 * Stack Arguments::
3009 * Register Arguments::
3010 * Scalar Return::
3011 * Aggregate Return::
3012 * Caller Saves::
3013 * Function Entry::
3014 * Profiling::
3015 * Tail Calls::
3016 * Stack Smashing Protection::
3017 @end menu
3018
3019 @node Frame Layout
3020 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
3021 @cindex stack frame layout
3022 @cindex frame layout
3023
3024 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3025 Here is the basic stack layout.
3026
3027 @defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3028 Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3029 pointer to a smaller address.
3030
3031 When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3032 compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3033 definition used does not matter.
3034 @end defmac
3035
3036 @defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3037 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3038 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3039 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3040
3041 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3042 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3043 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3044 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3045 space for the next item on the stack.
3046
3047 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3048 defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3049 which is often wrong.
3050 @end defmac
3051
3052 @defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3053 Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3054 are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3055 @end defmac
3056
3057 @defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3058 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3059 addresses on the stack.
3060 @end defmac
3061
3062 @defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3063 Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3064
3065 If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3066 subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3067 Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3068 value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3069 @c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3070 @c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
3071 @end defmac
3072
3073 @defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3074 Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3075 The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3076
3077 On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3078 is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3079 alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3080 stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3081 @end defmac
3082
3083 @defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3084 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3085 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3086 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3087
3088 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3089 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3090 @end defmac
3091
3092 @defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3093 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3094 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3095 function.
3096
3097 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3098 the first argument's address.
3099 @end defmac
3100
3101 @defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3102 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3103 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3104
3105 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3106 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3107 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3108 @end defmac
3109
3110 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3111 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3112 stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3113 @code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3114 default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3115 elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3116 @code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3117 @end defmac
3118
3119 @defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3120 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3121 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3122 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3123 itself.
3124
3125 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3126 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3127 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3128 @end defmac
3129
3130 @defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3131 If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3132 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3133 on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3134 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3135 define this macro.
3136 @end defmac
3137
3138 @hook TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
3139 This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3140 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3141 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3142 machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3143 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3144 @end deftypefn
3145
3146 @defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3147 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3148 address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3149 of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3150 You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3151 as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3152 @end defmac
3153
3154 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3155 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3156 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3157 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3158 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3159 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3160
3161 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3162 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3163 determine the return address of other frames.
3164 @end defmac
3165
3166 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3167 Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3168 from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3169 @end defmac
3170
3171 @defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3172 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3173 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3174 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3175 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3176 the stack.
3177
3178 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3179 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3180
3181 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3182 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3183 @end defmac
3184
3185 @defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3186 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3187 number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3188 must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3189 be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3190
3191 This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3192 general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3193 frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3194 over time.
3195 @end defmac
3196
3197 @defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3198 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3199 number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3200 only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3201 someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3202 terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3203 @end defmac
3204
3205 @hook TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC
3206 This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3207 contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3208 info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3209 @smallexample
3210 (set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3211 @end smallexample
3212 and
3213 @smallexample
3214 (set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3215 @end smallexample
3216 to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3217 the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3218 the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3219 @end deftypefn
3220
3221 @defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3222 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3223 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3224 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3225 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3226 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3227
3228 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3229 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3230 @end defmac
3231
3232 @defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3233 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3234 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3235 final value should coincide with that calculated by
3236 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3237 during virtual register instantiation.
3238
3239 The default value for this macro is
3240 @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3241 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3242 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3243 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3244 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3245
3246 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3247 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3248 DWARF 2.
3249 @end defmac
3250
3251 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3252 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3253 in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3254 The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3255 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3256
3257 Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3258 via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3259 variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3260 defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3261 based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3262 of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3263 should be defined.
3264 @end defmac
3265
3266 @defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3267 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3268 in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3269 in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3270 may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3271 @end defmac
3272
3273 @node Exception Handling
3274 @subsection Exception Handling Support
3275 @cindex exception handling
3276
3277 @defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3278 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3279 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3280 @var{N} registers are usable.
3281
3282 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3283 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3284 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3285 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
3286 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3287
3288 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3289 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3290 @end defmac
3291
3292 @defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3293 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3294 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3295 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3296 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3297
3298 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3299 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3300
3301 Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3302 by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3303 this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3304 stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3305 this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3306 that provided by DWARF 2.
3307 @end defmac
3308
3309 @defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3310 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3311 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3312 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3313
3314 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3315 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3316 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3317 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3318 frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3319 been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3320 target call frame.
3321
3322 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3323 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3324 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3325
3326 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3327 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3328 @end defmac
3329
3330 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3331 If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3332 to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3333 exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3334 using it to return to the exception handler.
3335 @end defmac
3336
3337 @defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3338 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3339 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3340 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3341 and so may be read-only.
3342
3343 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3344 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3345 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3346 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3347
3348 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3349 represented directly.
3350 @end defmac
3351
3352 @defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3353 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3354 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3355 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3356 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3357
3358 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3359 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3360 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3361 to be emitted.
3362 @end defmac
3363
3364 @defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3365 This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3366 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3367 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3368 through signal frames.
3369
3370 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3371 @file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3372 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3373 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3374 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3375 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3376 save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3377 evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3378 the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3379
3380 For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3381 @code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3382 @end defmac
3383
3384 @defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3385 This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3386 call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3387 usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3388
3389 This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in @file{unwind-ia64.c}.
3390 @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3391 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3392 for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3393 @code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3394 be updated in @var{fs}.
3395 @end defmac
3396
3397 @defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3398 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3399 info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3400 linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3401 @end defmac
3402
3403 @node Stack Checking
3404 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3405
3406 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3407 stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3408 three ways:
3409
3410 @enumerate
3411 @item
3412 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3413 will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3414 at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3415 other special processing.
3416
3417 @item
3418 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3419 @code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3420 that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3421 static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3422 in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3423 stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3424 approach below.
3425
3426 @item
3427 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3428 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3429 @end enumerate
3430
3431 If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3432 GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3433 @option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3434 dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3435
3436 @defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3437 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3438 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3439 is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3440 checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3441 value of this macro is zero.
3442 @end defmac
3443
3444 @defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3445 A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3446 in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3447 like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3448 approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3449 @end defmac
3450
3451 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3452 An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3453 instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3454 define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3455 the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3456 of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3457 @end defmac
3458
3459 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3460 An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3461 when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3462 contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3463 thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3464 is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3465 default value of this macro is zero.
3466 @end defmac
3467
3468 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3469 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3470 languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3471 with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
3472 8192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3473 most machines.
3474 @end defmac
3475
3476 The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3477 nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3478 in the opposite case.
3479
3480 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3481 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3482 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3483 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3484 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3485 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3486 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3487 @end defmac
3488
3489 @defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3490 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3491 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3492 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3493 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3494 use the default of four words.
3495 @end defmac
3496
3497 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3498 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3499 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3500 @option{-fstack-check}.
3501 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3502 normally not need to override that default.
3503 @end defmac
3504
3505 @need 2000
3506 @node Frame Registers
3507 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3508
3509 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3510 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3511
3512 @defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3513 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3514 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3515 the hardware determines which register this is.
3516 @end defmac
3517
3518 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3519 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3520 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3521 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3522 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3523 @end defmac
3524
3525 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3526 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3527 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3528 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3529 between these two locations). On those machines, define
3530 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3531 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3532 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3533 used for the frame pointer.
3534
3535 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3536 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3537 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3538 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3539 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3540 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3541 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3542
3543 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3544 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3545 @end defmac
3546
3547 @defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3548 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3549 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3550 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3551 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3552 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3553 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3554 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3555 (@pxref{Elimination}).
3556 @end defmac
3557
3558 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3559 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3560 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3561 the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3562 == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3563 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3564 @end defmac
3565
3566 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3567 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3568 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3569 same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3570 ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3571 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3572 @end defmac
3573
3574 @defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3575 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3576 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3577 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3578 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3579 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3580 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3581
3582 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3583 address from the stack.
3584 @end defmac
3585
3586 @defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3587 @defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3588 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3589 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3590 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3591 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3592 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3593 not be defined.
3594
3595 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3596
3597 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3598 defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3599 @end defmac
3600
3601 @hook TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN
3602 This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3603 targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3604 nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3605 attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3606 those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3607
3608 The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3609
3610 If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3611 provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3612 Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3613 from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3614 will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3615 @findex stack_pointer_rtx
3616 @findex frame_pointer_rtx
3617 @findex arg_pointer_rtx
3618 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3619 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3620 to refer to those items.
3621 @end deftypefn
3622
3623 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3624 This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3625 saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3626 DWARF2 exception handling.
3627
3628 Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3629 exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3630 extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3631 in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3632 used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3633 routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3634 registers that are not call-saved.
3635
3636 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3637 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3638 @end defmac
3639
3640 @defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3641
3642 This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3643 for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3644
3645 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3646 @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3647 @end defmac
3648
3649 @defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3650
3651 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3652 is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3653 Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3654 column number to use instead.
3655
3656 See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3657 @end defmac
3658
3659 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3660
3661 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3662 used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3663 debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3664 should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3665 @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3666
3667 @end defmac
3668
3669 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3670
3671 Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3672 that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3673 should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3674 .eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3675 return @code{@var{regno}}.
3676
3677 @end defmac
3678
3679 @node Elimination
3680 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3681
3682 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3683 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3684
3685 @hook TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3686 This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3687 a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3688 value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3689
3690 This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3691 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3692 constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3693 to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3694 Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3695 pointer.
3696
3697 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3698 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3699 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3700 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3701 them.
3702
3703 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3704 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3705 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3706
3707 Default return value is @code{false}.
3708 @end deftypefn
3709
3710 @findex get_frame_size
3711 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3712 A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3713 between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3714 the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3715 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3716 registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3717
3718 If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3719 need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3720 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3721 case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3722 @end defmac
3723
3724 @defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3725 If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3726 eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3727 defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3728 references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3729
3730 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3731 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3732
3733 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3734 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3735 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3736 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3737 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3738
3739 In this case, you might specify:
3740 @smallexample
3741 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3742 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3743 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3744 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3745 @end smallexample
3746
3747 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3748 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3749 @end defmac
3750
3751 @hook TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE
3752 This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3753 try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3754 @var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3755 is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3756 preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3757 knows about.
3758
3759 Default return value is @code{true}.
3760 @end deftypefn
3761
3762 @defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3763 This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3764 specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3765 registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3766 defined.
3767 @end defmac
3768
3769 @node Stack Arguments
3770 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3771 @cindex arguments on stack
3772 @cindex stack arguments
3773
3774 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3775 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3776 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3777
3778 @hook TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3779 This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3780 prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3781 passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3782 cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3783 The default is to not promote prototypes.
3784 @end deftypefn
3785
3786 @defmac PUSH_ARGS
3787 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3788 outgoing arguments.
3789 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3790 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3791 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3792 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3793 @end defmac
3794
3795 @defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3796 A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3797 last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3798 defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3799 and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3800 @end defmac
3801
3802 @defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3803 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3804 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3805
3806 On some machines, the definition
3807
3808 @smallexample
3809 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3810 @end smallexample
3811
3812 @noindent
3813 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3814 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3815 alignment. Then the definition should be
3816
3817 @smallexample
3818 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3819 @end smallexample
3820
3821 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
3822 @end defmac
3823
3824 @findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3825 @defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3826 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3827 will be computed and placed into the variable
3828 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3829 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3830 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3831
3832 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3833 is not proper.
3834 @end defmac
3835
3836 @defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3837 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3838 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3839 registers.
3840
3841 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3842 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3843 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3844 The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3845 of the function.
3846
3847 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3848 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3849 which.
3850 @end defmac
3851 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3852 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3853
3854 @defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3855 Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3856 caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3857 when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3858 if the function called is a library function.
3859
3860 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3861 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3862 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3863 @end defmac
3864
3865 @defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3866 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3867 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3868 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3869 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3870
3871 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3872 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3873 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3874 stack in its natural location.
3875 @end defmac
3876
3877 @hook TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS
3878 This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3879 a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3880 and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3881
3882 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3883 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3884 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3885 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3886
3887 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3888 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3889 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3890 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3891 arguments (if known).
3892
3893 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3894 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3895 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3896 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3897 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3898 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3899
3900 @var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3901 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3902 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3903
3904 On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3905 of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
3906 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3907 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3908 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3909 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3910 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3911 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3912 number of arguments.
3913 @end deftypefn
3914
3915 @defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3916 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3917 pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3918 when compiling a function call.
3919
3920 @var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3921 have been accumulated.
3922
3923 On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3924 that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3925 that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3926 call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3927 appropriate.
3928 @end defmac
3929
3930 @node Register Arguments
3931 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3932 @cindex arguments in registers
3933 @cindex registers arguments
3934
3935 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3936 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3937 the stack.
3938
3939 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG
3940 Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
3941 register and if so, which register.
3942
3943 The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
3944 arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3945 the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3946 (which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
3947 which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
3948 nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
3949 function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
3950 syntax error has previously occurred.
3951
3952 The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3953 register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
3954 on the stack.
3955
3956 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
3957 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
3958 @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
3959 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3960 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3961 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3962 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3963 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3964 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3965 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3966 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3967 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3968 argument is also stored on the stack.
3969
3970 The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
3971 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3972 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3973
3974 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
3975 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
3976 machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
3977 cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
3978 done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
3979 @var{named} is @code{false}.
3980
3981 @cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
3982 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
3983 You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
3984 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
3985 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
3986 is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
3987 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
3988 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
3989 a register.
3990 @end deftypefn
3991
3992 @hook TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
3993 This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
3994 solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
3995 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
3996 documentation.
3997 @end deftypefn
3998
3999 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
4000 Define this hook if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
4001 that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4002 necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4003 argument.
4004
4005 For such machines, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
4006 which the caller passes the value, and
4007 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
4008 fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
4009 arrive.
4010
4011 If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
4012 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
4013 @end deftypefn
4014
4015 @hook TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
4016 This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4017 argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4018 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4019 pushed on the stack.
4020
4021 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4022 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4023 first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4024 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4025 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4026 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4027 compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4028
4029 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
4030 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
4031 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
4032 @end deftypefn
4033
4034 @hook TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
4035 This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4036 position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4037 predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4038 passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4039
4040 If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4041 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4042 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4043 to that type.
4044 @end deftypefn
4045
4046 @hook TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES
4047 The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4048 known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4049 function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4050 by the caller.
4051
4052 For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4053 determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4054 not be generated.
4055
4056 The default version of this hook always returns false.
4057 @end deftypefn
4058
4059 @defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4060 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4061 of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4062 target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4063 of bytes of argument so far.
4064
4065 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4066 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4067 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4068 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4069 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4070 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4071 @end defmac
4072
4073 @defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4074 If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4075 function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4076 created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4077 reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4078 If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4079 @var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4080 @end defmac
4081
4082 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4083 A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4084 @var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4085 variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4086 is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4087 the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4088 For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4089 declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4090 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4091 being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4092 arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4093 parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4094 @var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4095
4096 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4097 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4098 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4099 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4100 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4101 never both of them at once.
4102 @end defmac
4103
4104 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4105 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4106 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4107 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4108 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
4109 0)} is used instead.
4110 @end defmac
4111
4112 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4113 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4114 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4115 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4116
4117 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4118 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4119 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4120 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4121 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4122 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4123 @end defmac
4124
4125 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE
4126 This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4127 advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4128 @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4129 the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4130 argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4131
4132 This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4133 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4134 used for arguments without any special help.
4135 @end deftypefn
4136
4137 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4138 If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4139 offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4140 which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4141 slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4142 top.
4143 @end defmac
4144
4145 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4146 If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4147 to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4148 @code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4149 @code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4150
4151 The @emph{amount} of padding is always just enough to reach the next
4152 multiple of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY}; this macro does not
4153 control it.
4154
4155 This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4156 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4157 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4158 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4159 @end defmac
4160
4161 @defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4162 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4163 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4164 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4165 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4166 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4167 @end defmac
4168
4169 @defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4170 Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4171 memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4172 macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4173 machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4174 @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4175 registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4176 a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4177 required.
4178 @end defmac
4179
4180 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY
4181 This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
4182 with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4183 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4184 @end deftypefn
4185
4186 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4187 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4188 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4189 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4190 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4191 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4192 stack.
4193 @end defmac
4194
4195 @hook TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG
4196 This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4197 as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4198 arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4199 to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4200 AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4201 registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4202 point register.
4203
4204 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4205 false.
4206 @end deftypefn
4207
4208 @hook TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST
4209 This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4210 The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4211 @end deftypefn
4212
4213 @hook TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P
4214 This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4215 to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4216 variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
4217 to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
4218 variable.
4219 The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
4220 this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4221 internal type.
4222 If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4223 Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4224 macro to iterate through all types.
4225 @end deftypefn
4226
4227 @hook TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST
4228 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4229 @var{fndecl}.
4230 The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4231 @end deftypefn
4232
4233 @hook TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE
4234 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4235 type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4236 @code{NULL_TREE}.
4237 @end deftypefn
4238
4239 @hook TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR
4240 This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4241 @code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4242 arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4243 @code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4244 @end deftypefn
4245
4246 @hook TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE
4247 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4248 with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4249 hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4250 @end deftypefn
4251
4252 @hook TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO
4253
4254 @hook TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4255 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4256 insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4257 considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4258 must work.
4259
4260 The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4261 required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4262 Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4263 code in @file{optabs.c}.
4264 @end deftypefn
4265
4266 @hook TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4267 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4268 insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4269 must have move patterns for this mode.
4270 @end deftypefn
4271
4272 @hook TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4273
4274 @hook TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P
4275 Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4276 small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4277 @var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4278 in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4279 In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4280 for any mode.
4281
4282 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4283 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4284 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4285 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4286 insn.
4287
4288 Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4289 in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4290 the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4291 classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4292 registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4293 registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4294 SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4295 strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4296 machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4297
4298 The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
4299 safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4300 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4301 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4302 to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4303 of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4304 @end deftypefn
4305
4306 @hook TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
4307
4308 @node Scalar Return
4309 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4310 @cindex return values in registers
4311 @cindex values, returned by functions
4312 @cindex scalars, returned as values
4313
4314 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4315 values---values that can fit in registers.
4316
4317 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE
4318
4319 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4320 returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4321 representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4322 representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4323 function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4324 compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4325 Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4326 a function returns a value.
4327
4328 On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4329 (Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4330 place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4331 @code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4332 The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4333 multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4334 @code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4335 location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4336 the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4337 that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4338 port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4339 @samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4340
4341 If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4342 the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4343 @var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4344
4345 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4346 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4347 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4348 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4349 known.
4350
4351 Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4352 which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4353 the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4354 different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4355
4356 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4357 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4358 @code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4359 @end deftypefn
4360
4361 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4362 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4363 a new target instead.
4364 @end defmac
4365
4366 @defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4367 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4368 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4369
4370 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4371 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4372 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4373 compiled.
4374 @end defmac
4375
4376 @hook TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE
4377 Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4378 function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4379
4380 The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4381 library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4382 representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4383
4384 If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4385 @end deftypefn
4386
4387 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4388 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4389 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4390
4391 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4392 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4393 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4394 suffices:
4395
4396 @smallexample
4397 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4398 @end smallexample
4399
4400 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4401 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4402 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4403
4404 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4405 for a new target instead.
4406 @end defmac
4407
4408 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
4409 A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4410 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4411
4412 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4413 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4414 recognized by this target hook.
4415
4416 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4417 function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4418 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4419
4420 If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4421 @end deftypefn
4422
4423 @defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4424 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4425 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4426 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4427 @end defmac
4428
4429 @hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB
4430 This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4431 at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4432 padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4433 is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4434
4435 Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4436 be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4437 or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
4438 4-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4439 @code{SImode} rtx.
4440 @end deftypefn
4441
4442 @node Aggregate Return
4443 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4444 @cindex aggregates as return values
4445 @cindex large return values
4446 @cindex returning aggregate values
4447 @cindex structure value address
4448
4449 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4450 cases), the value is not returned according to
4451 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4452 caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4453 should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4454 address}.
4455
4456 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4457 memory.
4458
4459 @hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY
4460 This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4461 function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4462 Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4463 will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4464 libcalls.
4465
4466 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4467 by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4468 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4469 possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4470 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4471 values, and 0 otherwise.
4472
4473 Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4474 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4475 to indicate this.
4476 @end deftypefn
4477
4478 @defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4479 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4480 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4481 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4482 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4483 and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4484 target hook.
4485
4486 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4487 @end defmac
4488
4489 @hook TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX
4490 This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4491 address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4492 passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4493 be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4494 hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4495 argument.
4496
4497 On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4498 is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4499 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4500 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4501 @var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4502 the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4503 the caller.
4504
4505 If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4506 stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4507 @var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4508 structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4509 to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4510 @end deftypefn
4511
4512 @defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4513 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4514 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4515 the address of a static variable containing the value.
4516
4517 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4518 pass an address to the subroutine.
4519
4520 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4521 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4522 @end defmac
4523
4524 @hook TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE
4525
4526 @hook TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE
4527
4528 @node Caller Saves
4529 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4530
4531 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4532 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4533 must live across calls.
4534
4535 @defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4536 A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4537 a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4538 restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4539 this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4540
4541 If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4542 machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4543 @end defmac
4544
4545 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4546 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4547 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4548 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4549 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4550 will select the smallest suitable mode.
4551 @end defmac
4552
4553 @node Function Entry
4554 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
4555 @cindex function entry and exit
4556 @cindex prologue
4557 @cindex epilogue
4558
4559 This section describes the macros that output function entry
4560 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4561
4562 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
4563 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4564 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4565 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4566 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4567 local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4568 stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4569
4570 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4571 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4572
4573 @findex regs_ever_live
4574 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4575 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4576 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4577 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4578 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4579 @code{regs_ever_live}.)
4580
4581 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4582 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4583 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4584 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4585 registers are used in the function.
4586
4587 @findex frame_pointer_needed
4588 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4589 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4590 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4591 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4592 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4593 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4594
4595 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4596 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4597 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4598 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4599 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4600 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4601 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4602 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4603 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4604 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4605 @end deftypefn
4606
4607 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE
4608 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4609 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4610 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4611 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4612 @end deftypefn
4613
4614 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE
4615 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4616 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4617 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4618 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4619 @end deftypefn
4620
4621 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
4622 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4623 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4624 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4625 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4626 same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4627 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4628 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4629
4630 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4631 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4632 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4633 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4634
4635 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4636 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4637 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4638 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4639 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4640 condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4641
4642 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4643 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4644 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4645 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4646 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4647 a function that needs a frame pointer.
4648
4649 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4650 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4651 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4652 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4653
4654 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4655 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4656 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4657 number of arguments.
4658
4659 @findex current_function_pops_args
4660 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4661 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4662 needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4663 function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4664 @code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4665 @end deftypefn
4666
4667 @itemize @bullet
4668 @item
4669 @findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4670 A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4671 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4672 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4673 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4674 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4675 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4676 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4677 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4678 features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4679
4680 @item
4681 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4682 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4683 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4684 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4685 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4686 a save area.
4687
4688 @item
4689 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4690 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4691 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4692 save area closer to the top of the stack.
4693
4694 @item
4695 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4696 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4697 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4698 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4699 @end itemize
4700
4701 @defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4702 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4703 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4704 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4705 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4706 default is 0.
4707
4708 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4709 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4710 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4711 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4712 @end defmac
4713
4714 @defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4715 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4716 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4717 pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4718 @end defmac
4719
4720 @defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4721 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4722 used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4723 on entry to an exception edge.
4724 @end defmac
4725
4726 @defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4727 Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4728 instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4729 definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4730 representing the number of delay slots there.
4731 @end defmac
4732
4733 @defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4734 A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4735 slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4736
4737 The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4738 being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4739 eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4740 of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4741 If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4742 may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4743 (at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4744 slot.
4745
4746 @findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4747 @findex final_scan_insn
4748 The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4749 list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4750 @code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
4751 delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
4752 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4753 outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4754 @code{final_scan_insn}.
4755
4756 You need not define this macro if you did not define
4757 @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4758 @end defmac
4759
4760 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4761 A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4762 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4763 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4764 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4765 the real function.
4766
4767 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4768 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4769 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4770 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4771 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4772 all other incoming arguments.
4773
4774 Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4775 made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4776 adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4777
4778 @smallexample
4779 p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4780 @end smallexample
4781
4782 After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4783 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4784 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4785 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4786
4787 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4788 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4789 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4790 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4791
4792 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4793 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4794 some targets, but probably not.
4795
4796 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4797 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4798 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4799 not support varargs.
4800 @end deftypefn
4801
4802 @hook TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4803 A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4804 to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4805 arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4806 generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4807 previously exposed.
4808 @end deftypefn
4809
4810 @node Profiling
4811 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4812 @cindex profiling, code generation
4813
4814 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4815
4816 @defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4817 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4818 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4819
4820 @findex mcount
4821 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4822 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4823 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4824 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4825
4826 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4827 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4828 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4829 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4830 @end defmac
4831
4832 @defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4833 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4834 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4835 not support profiling.
4836 @end defmac
4837
4838 @defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4839 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4840 @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4841 allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4842 implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4843 @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4844 @end defmac
4845
4846 @defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4847 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4848 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4849 @end defmac
4850
4851 @node Tail Calls
4852 @subsection Permitting tail calls
4853 @cindex tail calls
4854
4855 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
4856 True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4857 call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4858 or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4859
4860 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4861 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4862 during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4863 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4864 ``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4865 may vary greatly between different architectures.
4866 @end deftypefn
4867
4868 @hook TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY
4869 Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4870 function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4871 cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4872 registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4873 TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4874 FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4875 @end deftypefn
4876
4877 @node Stack Smashing Protection
4878 @subsection Stack smashing protection
4879 @cindex stack smashing protection
4880
4881 @hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD
4882 This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4883 for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4884 runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4885 that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4886 variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4887
4888 The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4889 @samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4890 @end deftypefn
4891
4892 @hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL
4893 This hook returns a tree expression that alerts the runtime that the
4894 stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4895 involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4896
4897 The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4898 @samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
4899 normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4900 @end deftypefn
4901
4902 @hook TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK
4903
4904 @node Varargs
4905 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4906 @cindex varargs implementation
4907
4908 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4909 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4910 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4911 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4912 conditionals to include it.
4913
4914 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4915 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4916 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4917 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4918 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4919 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4920
4921 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4922 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4923 below.
4924
4925 @defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
4926 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4927 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
4928 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4929 you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4930
4931 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4932 control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
4933 other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4934 found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4935
4936 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4937 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4938 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4939 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4940 to use them for its own purposes.
4941 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4942 @c 10feb93
4943 @end defmac
4944
4945 @defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
4946 This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
4947 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
4948 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4949 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4950 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4951 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4952 of the current function.
4953 @end defmac
4954
4955 @defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
4956 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4957 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4958 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
4959 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4960 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4961
4962 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4963 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
4964 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
4965
4966 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
4967 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
4968 @end defmac
4969
4970 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
4971
4972 @hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
4973 If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
4974 @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
4975 beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
4976 return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
4977 to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
4978 @end deftypefn
4979
4980 @hook TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
4981 This target hook offers an alternative to using
4982 @code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
4983 @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
4984 register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
4985 have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
4986 use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
4987 pass all their arguments on the stack.
4988
4989 The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
4990 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
4991 named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
4992 last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
4993
4994 The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
4995 argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
4996 store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
4997 variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
4998 store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
4999 frame.
5000
5001 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5002 compile time without knowing their data types,
5003 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5004 have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5005 for all data types.
5006
5007 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5008 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5009 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5010 end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5011 not generate any instructions in this case.
5012 @end deftypefn
5013
5014 @hook TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
5015 Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5016 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5017
5018 This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
5019 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5020 @code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5021 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5022 but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5023 then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5024 except the last are treated as named.
5025
5026 You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5027 @end deftypefn
5028
5029 @hook TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
5030 If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5031 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5032 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5033 defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5034 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5035 Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5036 @end deftypefn
5037
5038 @node Trampolines
5039 @section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5040 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
5041 @cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5042
5043 A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5044 when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5045 the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5046 tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5047 trampoline.
5048
5049 The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5050 address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5051 the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5052 two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5053 exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5054 machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5055 two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5056 operands.
5057
5058 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5059 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5060 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5061 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5062 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5063 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5064 separately.
5065
5066 @hook TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
5067 This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5068 on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5069 the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5070 label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5071
5072 If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5073 for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5074 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5075 to generate it on the spot.
5076 @end deftypefn
5077
5078 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5079 Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5080 (@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5081 @end defmac
5082
5083 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5084 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5085 @end defmac
5086
5087 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5088 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5089
5090 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5091 is used for aligning trampolines.
5092 @end defmac
5093
5094 @hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT
5095 This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5096 @var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5097 is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5098 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5099 when it is called.
5100
5101 If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5102 first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5103 from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5104 Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5105 trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5106 to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5107
5108 If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5109 enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5110 initializing the trampoline proper.
5111 @end deftypefn
5112
5113 @hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
5114 This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5115 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5116 memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5117 the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5118 address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5119 be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5120 If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5121 @end deftypefn
5122
5123 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5124 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5125 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5126 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5127
5128 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5129 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5130 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5131 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5132 latter makes initialization faster.
5133
5134 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5135 the following macro.
5136
5137 @defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5138 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5139 cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5140 typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5141 @var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5142 @end defmac
5143
5144 The operating system may also require the stack to be made executable
5145 before calling the trampoline. To implement this requirement, define
5146 the following macro.
5147
5148 @defmac ENABLE_EXECUTE_STACK
5149 Define this macro if certain operations must be performed before executing
5150 code located on the stack. The macro should expand to a series of C
5151 file-scope constructs (e.g.@: functions) and provide a unique entry point
5152 named @code{__enable_execute_stack}. The target is responsible for
5153 emitting calls to the entry point in the code, for example from the
5154 @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT} hook.
5155 @end defmac
5156
5157 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5158 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5159 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5160 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5161 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5162
5163 @defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5164 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5165 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5166 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5167 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5168
5169 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5170 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5171 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5172 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5173 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5174 special assembler code.
5175 @end defmac
5176
5177 @node Library Calls
5178 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5179 @cindex library subroutine names
5180 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5181
5182 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5183 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5184
5185 @defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5186 This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5187 expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5188 provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5189 are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5190 @end defmac
5191
5192 @findex set_optab_libfunc
5193 @findex init_one_libfunc
5194 @hook TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
5195 This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5196 existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5197 @code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5198 @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5199 library routines.
5200
5201 The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5202 @end deftypefn
5203
5204 @hook TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5205
5206 @defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5207 This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5208 implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5209 mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5210 return a tristate.
5211
5212 GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5213 comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5214 don't need to define this macro.
5215 @end defmac
5216
5217 @defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5218 This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5219 functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5220 operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5221 and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5222 If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5223 @minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5224 in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5225 @end defmac
5226
5227 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5228 @findex matherr
5229 @defmac TARGET_EDOM
5230 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5231 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5232 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5233 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5234 system.
5235
5236 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5237 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5238 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5239 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5240 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5241 @end defmac
5242
5243 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5244 @defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5245 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5246 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5247 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5248 macro, a reasonable default is used.
5249 @end defmac
5250
5251 @cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5252 @defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5253 When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5254 @code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
5255 default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5256 functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5257 systems that do support the C99 runtime.
5258 @end defmac
5259
5260 @cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5261 @defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5262 When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5263 and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}. The
5264 default is zero. The target has to provide the following functions:
5265 @smallexample
5266 void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5267 void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5268 void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5269 @end smallexample
5270 @end defmac
5271
5272 @defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5273 Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
5274 the calling convention of the NeXT system. This calling convention
5275 involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
5276 at once to the method-lookup library function.
5277
5278 The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
5279 to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5280 @end defmac
5281
5282 @node Addressing Modes
5283 @section Addressing Modes
5284 @cindex addressing modes
5285
5286 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5287 This is about addressing modes.
5288
5289 @defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5290 @defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5291 @defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5292 @defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5293 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5294 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5295 @end defmac
5296
5297 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5298 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5299 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5300 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5301 the size of the memory operand.
5302 @end defmac
5303
5304 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5305 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5306 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5307 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5308 @end defmac
5309
5310 @defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5311 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5312 is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5313 @code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5314 is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5315 constant addresses are supported.
5316 @end defmac
5317
5318 @defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5319 @code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5320 accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5321 known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5322 expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5323 @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5324 @end defmac
5325
5326 @defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5327 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5328 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5329 the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5330 accept.
5331 @end defmac
5332
5333 @hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
5334 A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5335 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5336
5337 Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5338 non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5339 desired by the caller.
5340
5341 The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5342 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5343 considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5344 kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5345 must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5346 up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5347 register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5348 if the array holds @code{-1}.
5349
5350 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5351 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5352 register is required.
5353
5354 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5355 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5356 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5357 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5358 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5359
5360 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5361 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5362 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5363 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5364 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5365
5366 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5367 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5368 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5369 target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5370 into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5371 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5372 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5373 Format}.
5374
5375 @cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5376 Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5377 this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5378 has this syntax:
5379
5380 @example
5381 #define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5382 @end example
5383
5384 @noindent
5385 and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5386 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5387
5388 @findex REG_OK_STRICT
5389 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5390 macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5391 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5392 that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5393
5394 Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5395 files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5396 @end deftypefn
5397
5398 @defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5399 A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5400 character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5401 letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5402 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5403 support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5404 semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5405 preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5406 @code{'m'} constraint.
5407 @end defmac
5408
5409 @defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5410 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5411 or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5412 can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5413 @code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5414
5415 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5416 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5417
5418 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5419 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5420 @end defmac
5421
5422 @hook TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5423 This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5424 operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5425 address.
5426
5427 @findex break_out_memory_refs
5428 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5429 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5430 @var{x}.
5431
5432 The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5433 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5434 should return the new @var{x}.
5435
5436 It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address.
5437 The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, it
5438 is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5439 a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5440 strategy can generate better code.
5441 @end deftypefn
5442
5443 @defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5444 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5445 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5446 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5447 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5448 performance reasons.
5449
5450 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5451 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5452 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5453 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5454 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5455 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5456 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5457 be shared.
5458
5459 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5460 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5461 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5462 of reload internals.
5463
5464 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5465 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5466 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5467
5468 @findex push_reload
5469 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5470 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5471 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5472
5473 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5474 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5475 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5476 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5477 @code{push_reload}.
5478
5479 @findex strict_memory_address_p
5480 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5481 the address has become legitimate.
5482
5483 @findex copy_rtx
5484 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5485 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5486 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5487 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5488 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5489 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5490 @end defmac
5491
5492 @hook TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P
5493 This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} can have
5494 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5495 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5496 but not others.
5497
5498 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5499 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5500 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5501 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5502
5503 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5504
5505 The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5506 @end deftypefn
5507
5508 @defmac GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
5509 A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
5510 @var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
5511 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5512 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5513 but not others.
5514
5515 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5516 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5517 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5518 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5519
5520 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5521
5522 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the
5523 @code{TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P} target hook.
5524 @end defmac
5525
5526 @hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P
5527 This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5528 @var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5529 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5530
5531 The default definition returns true.
5532 @end deftypefn
5533
5534 @hook TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5535 This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5536 @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5537 macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5538 references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5539 addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5540 the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5541 into their original form.
5542 @end deftypefn
5543
5544 @hook TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM
5545 This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5546 should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5547 of @var{x}.
5548
5549 The default version of this hook returns false.
5550
5551 The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5552 deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5553 from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5554 holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5555 of TLS symbols for various targets.
5556 @end deftypefn
5557
5558 @hook TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P
5559 This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5560 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5561 of @var{x}.
5562
5563 The default version returns false for all constants.
5564 @end deftypefn
5565
5566 @hook TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL
5567 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5568 the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5569 @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
5570 when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5571 @var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5572 of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5573 function are valid.
5574 @end deftypefn
5575
5576 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD
5577 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5578 address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5579 used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5580 @var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5581
5582 The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5583 @var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5584 the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5585 @code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5586 two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5587 @var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5588 the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5589 from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5590 @var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5591 @var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5592 @var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5593
5594 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5595 to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5596 use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5597 @code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5598 should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5599 described above.
5600 If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5601 the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5602 log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5603 @end deftypefn
5604
5605 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN
5606 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5607 widening multiplication of the even elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5608
5609 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5610 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD} target hook when vectorizing
5611 widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5612 preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5613 @code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5614 @end deftypefn
5615
5616 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD
5617 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5618 widening multiplication of the odd elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5619
5620 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5621 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN} target hook when vectorizing
5622 widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5623 preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5624 @code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5625 @end deftypefn
5626
5627 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST
5628 Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
5629 For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5630 misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
5631 @end deftypefn
5632
5633 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE
5634 Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5635 @end deftypefn
5636
5637 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM
5638 Target builtin that implements vector permute.
5639 @end deftypefn
5640
5641 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM_OK
5642 Return true if a vector created for @code{builtin_vec_perm} is valid.
5643 @end deftypefn
5644
5645 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION
5646 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5647 input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5648 The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5649 specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5650 (truncation, rounding, etc.).
5651
5652 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5653 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5654 conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5655 @end deftypefn
5656
5657 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION
5658 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5659 vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5660 @var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5661 The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5662 return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5663 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5664 @end deftypefn
5665
5666 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT
5667 This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5668 store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5669 parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5670 the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5671 parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5672 @end deftypefn
5673
5674 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE
5675 This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5676 mode @var{mode}. The default is
5677 equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
5678 transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5679 @end deftypefn
5680
5681 @hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES
5682 This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5683 after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5684 mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5685 The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5686 @end deftypefn
5687
5688 @node Anchored Addresses
5689 @section Anchored Addresses
5690 @cindex anchored addresses
5691 @cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5692
5693 GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5694 For example, if we have:
5695
5696 @smallexample
5697 static int a, b, c;
5698 int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5699 @end smallexample
5700
5701 the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5702 addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5703 it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5704 the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5705 be something like:
5706
5707 @smallexample
5708 int foo (void)
5709 @{
5710 register int *xr = &x;
5711 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5712 @}
5713 @end smallexample
5714
5715 (which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5716 ``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5717
5718 The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5719 in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5720 section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5721 or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5722
5723 @hook TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5724 The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5725 On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5726 applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5727 for every mode. The default value is 0.
5728 @end deftypevr
5729
5730 @hook TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5731 Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5732 offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5733 value is 0.
5734 @end deftypevr
5735
5736 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR
5737 Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5738 @code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5739 The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5740 of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5741
5742 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5743 it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5744 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5745 is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5746 @end deftypefn
5747
5748 @hook TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P
5749 Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5750 @var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5751 @samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5752
5753 The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5754 intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5755 or target-specific sections.
5756 @end deftypefn
5757
5758 @node Condition Code
5759 @section Condition Code Status
5760 @cindex condition code status
5761
5762 The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5763 two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5764
5765 The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5766 (@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5767 clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5768 register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5769 architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5770 most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5771 most RISC machines.
5772
5773 The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5774 the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5775 insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5776 optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5777 is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5778 three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5779 scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5780 separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5781
5782 For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5783 represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5784 condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5785 condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5786 or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5787 Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5788 that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5789
5790 Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5791 specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5792 interested in most macros in this section.
5793
5794 @menu
5795 * CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5796 * MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
5797 * Cond Exec Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
5798 @end menu
5799
5800 @node CC0 Condition Codes
5801 @subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5802 @findex cc0
5803
5804 @findex cc_status
5805 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5806 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5807 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5808 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5809 currently based, and several standard flags.
5810
5811 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5812 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5813 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5814
5815 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5816 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5817 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5818
5819 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5820 @end defmac
5821
5822 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5823 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5824 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5825 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5826 define this macro to initialize it.
5827
5828 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5829 @end defmac
5830
5831 @defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5832 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5833 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5834 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5835 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5836 set @code{(cc0)}.
5837
5838 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5839
5840 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5841 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5842 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5843 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5844 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5845 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5846 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5847 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5848 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5849 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5850 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5851 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5852 condition code value.
5853
5854 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5855 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5856 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5857 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5858 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5859 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5860 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5861
5862 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5863 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5864 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5865 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5866 @end defmac
5867
5868 @node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5869 @subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5870 @findex CCmode
5871 @findex MODE_CC
5872
5873 @defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5874 On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5875 than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5876 code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5877 when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5878 bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5879 branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5880 this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5881 record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5882 also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5883 unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5884
5885 If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5886 @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5887 a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5888 have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5889 by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5890 be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5891 the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5892
5893 @smallexample
5894 (define_insn ""
5895 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
5896 (compare:CC_NOOV
5897 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
5898 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
5899 (const_int 0)))]
5900 ""
5901 "@dots{}")
5902 @end smallexample
5903
5904 @noindent
5905 together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
5906 for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
5907
5908 @smallexample
5909 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
5910 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
5911 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
5912 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
5913 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
5914 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
5915 @end smallexample
5916
5917 Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
5918 were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
5919 this section.
5920
5921 You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
5922 in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
5923 @end defmac
5924
5925 @defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
5926 On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
5927 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
5928 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
5929 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
5930
5931 On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
5932 required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
5933 and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
5934 comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
5935 @var{op1} as required.
5936
5937 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
5938 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
5939 @file{md} file.
5940
5941 You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
5942 code or operands.
5943 @end defmac
5944
5945 @defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
5946 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
5947 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
5948 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
5949 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
5950
5951 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
5952 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
5953 For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
5954 inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
5955
5956 @smallexample
5957 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
5958 @end smallexample
5959 @end defmac
5960
5961 @defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
5962 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
5963 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
5964 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
5965 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
5966 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
5967 freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
5968 like:
5969
5970 @smallexample
5971 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
5972 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
5973 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
5974 @end smallexample
5975 @end defmac
5976
5977 @hook TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS
5978 On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
5979 register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
5980 regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
5981 hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
5982 small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
5983 to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
5984 arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
5985 When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
5986 integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
5987 @code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
5988
5989 The default version of this hook returns false.
5990 @end deftypefn
5991
5992 @hook TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE
5993 On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
5994 @code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
5995 validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
5996 target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
5997 both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
5998 return @code{VOIDmode}.
5999
6000 The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6001 same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6002 returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6003 @end deftypefn
6004
6005 @node Cond Exec Macros
6006 @subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6007 @findex conditional execution
6008 @findex predication
6009
6010 There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6011 supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6012 represent conditional branches.
6013
6014 @defmac REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{op1}, @var{op2})
6015 A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
6016 @var{op1}, a comparison operation, is the inverse of @var{op2} and vice
6017 versa. Define this to return 0 if the target has conditional execution
6018 predicates that cannot be reversed safely. There is no need to validate
6019 that the arguments of op1 and op2 are the same, this is done separately.
6020 If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as follows:
6021
6022 @smallexample
6023 #define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
6024 (GET_CODE ((x)) == reversed_comparison_code ((y), NULL))
6025 @end smallexample
6026 @end defmac
6027
6028 @node Costs
6029 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6030 @cindex costs of instructions
6031 @cindex relative costs
6032 @cindex speed of instructions
6033
6034 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6035 on the target machine.
6036
6037 @defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6038 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6039 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6040 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6041 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6042 that.
6043
6044 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6045 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6046 registers if they are not general registers.
6047
6048 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6049 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6050 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6051 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6052 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6053 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6054
6055 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6056 @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6057 @end defmac
6058
6059 @hook TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST
6060 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6061 from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6062 are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6063 A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6064 that.
6065
6066 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6067 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6068 registers if they are not general registers.
6069
6070 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6071 hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6072 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6073 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6074 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6075 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6076
6077 The default version of this function returns 2.
6078 @end deftypefn
6079
6080 @defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6081 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6082 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6083 is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6084 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6085 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6086 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6087
6088 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6089 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6090 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6091 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6092 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6093 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6094
6095 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6096 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6097 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6098 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6099 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6100 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6101 are the same as to this macro.
6102
6103 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6104 @code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6105 @end defmac
6106
6107 @hook TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST
6108 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6109 between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
6110 if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6111 This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6112 If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6113 registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6114
6115 If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6116 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6117 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6118 between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
6119 more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6120 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6121
6122 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6123 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6124 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6125 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6126 4 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6127 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6128 are the same as to this target hook.
6129 @end deftypefn
6130
6131 @defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6132 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6133 the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6134 @var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6135 for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6136 optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6137 true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6138 @code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
6139 @end defmac
6140
6141 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6142 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6143 ordinarily expect.
6144
6145 @defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6146 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6147 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6148 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6149 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6150 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6151
6152 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6153 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6154 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6155 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6156 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6157 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6158 @end defmac
6159
6160 @defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6161 Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6162 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6163 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6164 handler.
6165
6166 When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6167 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6168 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6169 Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6170 cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6171
6172 If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6173 this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6174 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6175 @end defmac
6176
6177 @defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6178 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6179 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6180 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6181 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6182
6183 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6184 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6185 the number of such sequences.
6186
6187 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6188 optimized for speed rather than size.
6189
6190 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6191 @end defmac
6192
6193 @defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6194 A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6195 copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6196 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6197 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6198 @end defmac
6199
6200 @defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6201 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6202 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6203 @end defmac
6204
6205 @defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6206 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6207 of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6208 or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6209 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6210
6211 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6212 optimized for speed rather than size.
6213
6214 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6215 @end defmac
6216
6217 @defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6218 A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6219 to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6220 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6221 than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6222 @end defmac
6223
6224 @defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6225 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6226 of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6227 a block set insn or a library call.
6228 Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6229 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6230
6231 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6232 optimized for speed rather than size.
6233
6234 If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6235 @end defmac
6236
6237 @defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6238 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6239 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6240 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
6241 storing values other than constant zero.
6242 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6243 than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6244 @end defmac
6245
6246 @defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6247 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6248 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6249 other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6250 called with a constant source string.
6251 Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6252 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6253 @end defmac
6254
6255 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6256 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6257 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6258 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6259 @end defmac
6260
6261 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6262 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6263 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6264 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6265 @end defmac
6266
6267 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6268 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6269 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6270 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6271 @end defmac
6272
6273 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6274 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6275 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6276 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6277 @end defmac
6278
6279 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6280 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6281 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6282 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6283 @end defmac
6284
6285 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6286 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6287 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6288 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6289 @end defmac
6290
6291 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6292 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6293 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6294 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6295 @end defmac
6296
6297 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6298 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6299 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6300 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6301 @end defmac
6302
6303 @defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6304 Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6305 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6306 @end defmac
6307
6308 @defmac RANGE_TEST_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6309 Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6310 @samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6311 @code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6312 @end defmac
6313
6314 @hook TARGET_RTX_COSTS
6315 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6316
6317 The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6318 available for examination in @var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression
6319 in which it is contained, found in @var{outer_code}. @var{code} is the
6320 expression code---redundant, since it can be obtained with
6321 @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
6322
6323 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6324 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6325 instructions.
6326
6327 On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6328 for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6329 necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6330 for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6331 operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6332
6333 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6334 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6335 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6336
6337 The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6338 processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6339 @end deftypefn
6340
6341 @hook TARGET_ADDRESS_COST
6342 This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6343 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6344 the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6345
6346 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6347 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6348 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6349 all addresses will have equal costs.
6350
6351 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6352 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6353 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6354
6355 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6356 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6357 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6358 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6359 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6360 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6361 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6362 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6363
6364 This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6365
6366 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6367 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6368 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6369 be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6370 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6371 should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6372 should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6373 registers on machines with lots of registers.
6374 @end deftypefn
6375
6376 @node Scheduling
6377 @section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6378
6379 The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6380 adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6381 hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6382 them: try the first ones in this list first.
6383
6384 @hook TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
6385 This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6386 issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6387 Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6388 an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6389 constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6390 hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6391 This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6392 it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6393 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6394 @end deftypefn
6395
6396 @hook TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE
6397 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6398 from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6399 still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6400 @samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6401 @code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6402 You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6403 than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6404 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6405 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6406 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6407 was scheduled.
6408 @end deftypefn
6409
6410 @hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST
6411 This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6412 relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6413 dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6414 is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6415 to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6416 that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6417 data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6418 description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6419 output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6420 times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6421 acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6422 @pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6423 @end deftypefn
6424
6425 @hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY
6426 This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6427 @var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6428 execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6429 later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6430 scheduling priorities of insns.
6431 @end deftypefn
6432
6433 @hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER
6434 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6435 list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6436 combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6437 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6438 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6439 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6440 list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6441 a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6442 reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6443 @var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6444 is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6445 the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6446 can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6447 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6448 @end deftypefn
6449
6450 @hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2
6451 Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6452 function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6453 is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6454 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6455 return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6456 this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6457 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6458 cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6459 @end deftypefn
6460
6461 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK
6462 This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6463 chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6464 correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6465 example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6466 analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6467 dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6468 calculated.
6469 @end deftypefn
6470
6471 @hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT
6472 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6473 instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6474 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6475 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6476 @var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6477 region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6478 scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6479 @end deftypefn
6480
6481 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH
6482 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6483 instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6484 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6485 is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6486 to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6487 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6488 @end deftypefn
6489
6490 @hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL
6491 This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6492 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6493 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6494 @var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6495 @end deftypefn
6496
6497 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL
6498 This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6499 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6500 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6501 @end deftypefn
6502
6503 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6504 The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6505 pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6506 when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6507 simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6508 processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6509 based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6510 when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6511 @end deftypefn
6512
6513 @hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6514 The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6515 @end deftypefn
6516
6517 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6518 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6519 to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6520 simulated processor cycle finishes.
6521 @end deftypefn
6522
6523 @hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6524 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6525 used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6526 @end deftypefn
6527
6528 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6529 The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6530 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6531 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6532 state on a single insn is not enough.
6533 @end deftypefn
6534
6535 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6536 The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6537 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6538 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6539 state on a single insn is not enough.
6540 @end deftypefn
6541
6542 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD
6543 This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6544 for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6545 chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6546 value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6547 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6548 subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6549 maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6550 @acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6551 packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6552 rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6553
6554 This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6555 processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6556 with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6557 @var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6558 @var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6559 processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6560 @var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6561 until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6562 the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6563
6564 Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6565 pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6566 schedules to choose the best one.
6567
6568 The default is no multipass scheduling.
6569 @end deftypefn
6570
6571 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD
6572
6573 This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6574 considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6575 zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6576 be issued.
6577
6578 The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6579 @end deftypefn
6580
6581 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN
6582 This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6583 scheduling.
6584 @end deftypefn
6585
6586 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE
6587 This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6588 @end deftypefn
6589
6590 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK
6591 This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6592 an instruction.
6593 @end deftypefn
6594
6595 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END
6596 This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6597 round of multipass scheduling.
6598 @end deftypefn
6599
6600 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT
6601 This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6602 @end deftypefn
6603
6604 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI
6605 This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6606 @end deftypefn
6607
6608 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE
6609 This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6610 on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6611 @var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6612 the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6613 is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6614 start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6615 verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6616 @var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6617 processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6618 and the current processor cycle.
6619 @end deftypefn
6620
6621 @hook TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE
6622 This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6623 the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6624 are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6625 to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6626 being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6627 dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6628 parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6629 The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6630 insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6631 and @code{false} otherwise.
6632
6633 Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6634 where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6635 delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6636 that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6637 important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6638 closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6639 not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6640 @end deftypefn
6641
6642 @hook TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED
6643 This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6644 the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6645 per instruction data structures.
6646 @end deftypefn
6647
6648 @hook TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT
6649 Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6650 @end deftypefn
6651
6652 @hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT
6653 Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6654 It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6655 beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6656 @end deftypefn
6657
6658 @hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT
6659 Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6660 @end deftypefn
6661
6662 @hook TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT
6663 Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6664 @end deftypefn
6665
6666 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT
6667 Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6668 @end deftypefn
6669
6670 @hook TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN
6671 This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6672 speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6673 The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6674 version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6675 pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6676 or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6677 speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6678 the generated speculative pattern.
6679 @end deftypefn
6680
6681 @hook TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P
6682 This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6683 for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6684 instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6685 @end deftypefn
6686
6687 @hook TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK
6688 This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6689 check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6690 speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6691 @var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6692 be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6693 recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6694 a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6695 @var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6696 @end deftypefn
6697
6698 @hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC
6699 This hook is used as a workaround for
6700 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6701 called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
6702 discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6703 being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6704 @var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6705 For non-speculative instructions,
6706 the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
6707 the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6708 is nearly full.
6709 @end deftypefn
6710
6711 @hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS
6712 This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6713 enabled/used.
6714 The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6715 The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6716 @end deftypefn
6717
6718 @hook TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII
6719 This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6720 resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6721 the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6722 backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6723 bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6724 of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6725 @end deftypefn
6726
6727 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH
6728 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6729 is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6730 @end deftypefn
6731
6732 @hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO
6733 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6734 in its second parameter.
6735 @end deftypefn
6736
6737 @hook TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
6738
6739 @node Sections
6740 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6741 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6742 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6743
6744 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6745 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6746 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6747 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6748 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6749 of sections.
6750
6751 @file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6752 @code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6753 The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6754 is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6755 as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6756 initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6757 They may however depend on command-line flags.
6758
6759 @emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6760 use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6761 to be string literals.
6762
6763 Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6764 section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6765 should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6766 @code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6767
6768 You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6769 @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6770 in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6771 @code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6772 create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6773 reuse @code{text_section}.
6774
6775 All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6776 if the target does not provide them.
6777
6778 @defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6779 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6780 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6781 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6782 @end defmac
6783
6784 @defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6785 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6786 frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6787 a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6788 @end defmac
6789
6790 @defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6791 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6792 executed functions in the program.
6793 @end defmac
6794
6795 @defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6796 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6797 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6798 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6799 @end defmac
6800
6801 @defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6802 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6803 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6804 initialized, writable small data.
6805 @end defmac
6806
6807 @defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6808 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6809 assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6810 data.
6811 @end defmac
6812
6813 @defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6814 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6815 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6816 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
6817 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
6818 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6819 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6820 used.
6821 @end defmac
6822
6823 @defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6824 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6825 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6826 uninitialized, writable small data.
6827 @end defmac
6828
6829 @defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6830 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6831 assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6832 common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6833 @end defmac
6834
6835 @defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6836 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6837 containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6838 default is @code{'T'}.
6839 @end defmac
6840
6841 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6842 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6843 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6844 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6845 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6846 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6847 @end defmac
6848
6849 @defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6850 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6851 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6852 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6853 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6854 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6855 @end defmac
6856
6857 @defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6858 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6859 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6860 part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6861 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6862 both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6863 @end defmac
6864
6865 @defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6866 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6867 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6868 part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6869 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6870 both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6871 @end defmac
6872
6873 @defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
6874 If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6875 via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6876 the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6877 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6878 to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6879 sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
6880 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6881 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6882 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
6883 @end defmac
6884
6885 @defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6886 If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6887 variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
6888 when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6889 you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6890 they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6891 expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
6892 MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
6893 require small data support from your application, but use this macro
6894 to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
6895 access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
6896 @end defmac
6897
6898 @defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
6899 If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
6900 arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
6901 @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
6902 and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
6903 @end defmac
6904
6905 @defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
6906 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
6907 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
6908 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
6909 readonly data section is used.
6910
6911 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
6912 @end defmac
6913
6914 @hook TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS
6915 Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
6916 @file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
6917 of its own that you need to create.
6918
6919 GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
6920 any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
6921 described below.
6922 @end deftypefn
6923
6924 @hook TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK
6925 Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
6926 selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
6927 should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
6928 local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
6929
6930 The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
6931 is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
6932 when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
6933 in read-only sections even in executables.
6934 @end deftypefn
6935
6936 @hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION
6937 Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
6938 assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
6939 some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
6940 requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
6941 local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
6942 @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
6943
6944 The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
6945 variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
6946
6947 See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
6948 @end deftypefn
6949
6950 @defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
6951 Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
6952 for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
6953
6954 In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
6955 function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
6956 it is unlikely to be called.
6957 @end defmac
6958
6959 @hook TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION
6960 Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
6961 and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
6962 As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
6963 the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
6964
6965 The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
6966 ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
6967 example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
6968 Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
6969 @end deftypefn
6970
6971 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION
6972 Return the readonly data section associated with
6973 @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
6974 The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
6975 the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
6976 if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
6977 otherwise.
6978 @end deftypefn
6979
6980 @hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION
6981 Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
6982 should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
6983 constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
6984 case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
6985 in bits.
6986
6987 The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
6988 constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
6989 else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
6990 @end deftypefn
6991
6992 @hook TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME
6993 Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
6994 by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
6995 the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
6996 or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
6997 hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
6998 your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
6999 returns the @var{id} provided.
7000 @end deftypefn
7001
7002 @hook TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
7003 Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7004 treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7005 function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7006
7007 The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7008 @var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7009 an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7010 rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7011 in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7012
7013 In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7014 a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7015 will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7016 register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7017 rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7018 leave it alone.)
7019
7020 The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7021 that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7022 be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7023 declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7024 declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7025 @var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7026
7027 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7028 The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7029 @code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7030 Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7031 encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7032 discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7033
7034 The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7035 in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7036 @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7037 before overriding it.
7038 @end deftypefn
7039
7040 @hook TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING
7041 Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7042 the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7043 may have added.
7044 @end deftypefn
7045
7046 @hook TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
7047 Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7048 The default version of this hook always returns false.
7049 @end deftypefn
7050
7051 @hook TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7052 Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7053 ``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7054 @end deftypevr
7055
7056 @hook TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
7057
7058 @hook TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P
7059 Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7060 rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7061 or executable image).
7062
7063 The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7064 for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7065 currently supported object file formats.
7066 @end deftypefn
7067
7068 @hook TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7069 Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7070 The default value is false.
7071 @end deftypevr
7072
7073
7074 @node PIC
7075 @section Position Independent Code
7076 @cindex position independent code
7077 @cindex PIC
7078
7079 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7080 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7081 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7082 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7083 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7084 must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7085 when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7086 need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7087 relative addresses.
7088 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7089 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7090
7091 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7092 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7093 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7094 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7095 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7096 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7097 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7098 necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7099 when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7100 @end defmac
7101
7102 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
7103 A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7104 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7105 the default is zero. Do not define
7106 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7107 @end defmac
7108
7109 @defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7110 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7111 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7112 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7113 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7114 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7115 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7116 position independent code.
7117 @end defmac
7118
7119 @node Assembler Format
7120 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7121
7122 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7123 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7124 instructions do.
7125
7126 @menu
7127 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7128 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7129 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7130 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7131 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7132 and termination routines.
7133 * Macros for Initialization::
7134 Specific macros that control the handling of
7135 initialization and termination routines.
7136 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7137 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7138 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7139 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7140 @end menu
7141
7142 @node File Framework
7143 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7144 @cindex assembler format
7145 @cindex output of assembler code
7146
7147 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7148 This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7149
7150 @findex default_file_start
7151 @hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START
7152 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7153 find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7154 by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7155 quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7156 @code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7157 lets other target files rely on these variables.
7158 @end deftypefn
7159
7160 @hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7161 If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7162 printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7163 @option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7164 to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7165 definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7166 assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7167 whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7168
7169 The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7170 verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7171 comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7172 @end deftypevr
7173
7174 @hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7175 If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7176 for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7177 @code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7178 this to be done. The default is false.
7179 @end deftypevr
7180
7181 @hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_END
7182 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7183 to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7184 @end deftypefn
7185
7186 @deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7187 Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7188 special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7189 the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7190 should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7191 need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7192 this function.
7193 @end deftypefun
7194
7195 @hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_START
7196 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7197 to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7198 nothing.
7199 @end deftypefn
7200
7201 @hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_END
7202 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7203 to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7204 nothing.
7205 @end deftypefn
7206
7207 @hook TARGET_ASM_CODE_END
7208 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7209 unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7210 here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7211 because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7212 nothing.
7213 @end deftypefn
7214
7215 @defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7216 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7217 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7218 the end of the line.
7219 @end defmac
7220
7221 @defmac ASM_APP_ON
7222 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7223 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7224 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7225 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7226 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7227 @end defmac
7228
7229 @defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7230 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7231 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7232 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7233 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7234 @end defmac
7235
7236 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7237 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7238 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7239 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7240
7241 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7242 for the file format in use is appropriate.
7243 @end defmac
7244
7245 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
7246
7247 @defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7248 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7249 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7250 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7251 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7252 of the filename using this macro.
7253 @end defmac
7254
7255 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7256 A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
7257 @samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}. If this
7258 macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
7259 @end defmac
7260
7261 @hook TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION
7262 Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7263 should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7264 of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7265 is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7266 this section is associated.
7267 @end deftypefn
7268
7269 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION
7270 Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7271 Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
7272 functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
7273 at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7274 @var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7275 (from static destructors).
7276 Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7277 @end deftypefn
7278
7279 @hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS
7280
7281 @hook TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7282 This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7283 It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
7284 @end deftypevr
7285
7286 @anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7287 @hook TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7288 This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7289 section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7290 This is true on most ELF targets.
7291 @end deftypevr
7292
7293 @hook TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS
7294 Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7295 based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7296 declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7297 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7298
7299 The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7300 read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7301 need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7302 set via @code{__attribute__}.
7303 @end deftypefn
7304
7305 @hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES
7306 Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7307 switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7308 enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7309 It can take the following values:
7310
7311 @table @gcctabopt
7312 @item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7313 @var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7314
7315 @item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7316 @var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7317 direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7318 default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7319 command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7320 various different individual optimization passes.
7321
7322 @item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7323 @var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7324 ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7325 target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7326 time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7327 warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7328 wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7329 necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7330 perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7331 switches.
7332
7333 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7334 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7335
7336 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7337 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7338 @end table
7339
7340 The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7341 supported in the future.
7342
7343 By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7344 provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7345 it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7346 section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7347 provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7348 hook.
7349 @end deftypefn
7350
7351 @hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7352 This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7353 ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7354 hook.
7355 @end deftypevr
7356
7357 @need 2000
7358 @node Data Output
7359 @subsection Output of Data
7360
7361
7362 @hook TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7363 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7364 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7365 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7366 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7367 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7368 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7369 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7370 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7371 These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7372 of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7373 byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7374 aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7375 @code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7376
7377 The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7378 followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7379 the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7380 @end deftypevr
7381
7382 @hook TARGET_ASM_INTEGER
7383 The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7384 integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7385 in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7386 function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7387 object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7388 split the object into smaller parts.
7389
7390 The default implementation of this hook will use the
7391 @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7392 when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7393 @end deftypefn
7394
7395 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA
7396 A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7397 can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7398 the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7399 @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7400
7401 If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7402 so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7403 itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7404 return @code{true}.
7405 @end deftypefn
7406
7407 @defmac OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{fail})
7408 A C statement to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that
7409 @code{output_addr_const} can't deal with, and output assembly code to
7410 @var{stream} corresponding to the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to
7411 allow machine-dependent @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7412
7413 If @code{OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA} fails to recognize a pattern, it must
7414 @code{goto fail}, so that a standard error message is printed. If it
7415 prints an error message itself, by calling, for example,
7416 @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just complete normally.
7417 @end defmac
7418
7419 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7420 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7421 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7422 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7423 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7424
7425 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7426 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7427 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7428 @end defmac
7429
7430 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7431 A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7432 @var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7433 is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7434 @end defmac
7435
7436 @defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7437 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7438 expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7439 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7440 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7441 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7442 pool before the function.
7443 @end defmac
7444
7445 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7446 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7447 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7448 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7449 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7450 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7451 immediately after this call.
7452
7453 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7454 not be defined.
7455 @end defmac
7456
7457 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7458 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7459 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7460 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7461
7462 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7463 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7464 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7465 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7466 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7467 alignment.
7468
7469 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7470 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7471 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7472 Here is how to do this:
7473
7474 @smallexample
7475 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7476 @end smallexample
7477
7478 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7479 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7480 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7481
7482 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7483 @end defmac
7484
7485 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7486 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7487 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7488 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7489 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7490 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7491
7492 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7493 define this macro.
7494 @end defmac
7495
7496 @defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7497 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7498 used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7499 to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7500 a line separator uses multiple characters.
7501
7502 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7503 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7504 @end defmac
7505
7506 @hook TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7507 These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7508 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7509 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7510 @end deftypevr
7511
7512 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7513 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7514
7515 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7516 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7517 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7518 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7519 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7520 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7521 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7522 target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7523 the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7524 @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7525 simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7526 @code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7527 by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7528 it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
7529 32 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7530 on the host machine.
7531
7532 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7533 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7534 machine's memory.
7535 @end defmac
7536
7537 @node Uninitialized Data
7538 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7539
7540 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7541 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7542
7543 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7544 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7545 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7546 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7547 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7548 possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7549 other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7550 backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7551 byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7552 equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7553 the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7554 an ordinary undefined external.
7555
7556 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7557 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7558 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7559
7560 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7561 common global variables are output.
7562 @end defmac
7563
7564 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7565 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7566 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7567 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7568 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7569 as the number of bits.
7570 @end defmac
7571
7572 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7573 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7574 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7575 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7576 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7577 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7578 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7579 @end defmac
7580
7581 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7582 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7583 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7584 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
7585 is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
7586
7587 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7588 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
7589 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7590 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7591 the name, and a newline.
7592
7593 There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
7594 The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7595 switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7596 You do not need to do both.
7597
7598 Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7599 non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7600 efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7601 not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7602 common in order to save space in the object file.
7603 @end defmac
7604
7605 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7606 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7607 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7608 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7609 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7610
7611 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7612 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7613 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7614
7615 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7616 static variables are output.
7617 @end defmac
7618
7619 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7620 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7621 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7622 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7623 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7624 as the number of bits.
7625 @end defmac
7626
7627 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7628 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7629 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7630 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7631 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7632 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7633 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7634 @end defmac
7635
7636 @node Label Output
7637 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7638
7639 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7640 This is about outputting labels.
7641
7642 @findex assemble_name
7643 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7644 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7645 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7646 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7647 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7648 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7649 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7650 @end defmac
7651
7652 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7653 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7654 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7655 a function.
7656 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7657 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7658 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7659 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7660
7661 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7662 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7663 @end defmac
7664
7665 @findex assemble_name_raw
7666 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7667 Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7668 to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7669 @code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7670 that it is more efficient.
7671 @end defmac
7672
7673 @defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7674 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7675 size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7676 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7677 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7678
7679 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7680 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7681 for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7682 macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7683 define this macro.
7684 @end defmac
7685
7686 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7687 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7688 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7689 symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7690 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7691 provided.
7692 @end defmac
7693
7694 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7695 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7696 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7697 the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7698 address.
7699
7700 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7701 provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7702 @samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7703 the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7704 not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7705 to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7706 @end defmac
7707
7708 @defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7709 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7710 type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7711 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7712 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7713
7714 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7715 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7716 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7717 types at all, do not define this macro.
7718 @end defmac
7719
7720 @defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7721 A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7722 the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7723 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7724 the default is not to define this macro.
7725
7726 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7727 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7728 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7729 types at all, do not define this macro.
7730 @end defmac
7731
7732 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7733 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7734 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7735 symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7736 that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7737 you should not count on this.
7738
7739 If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7740 definition of this macro is provided.
7741 @end defmac
7742
7743 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7744 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7745 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7746 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7747 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7748 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
7749 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7750
7751 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7752 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
7753
7754 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7755 of this macro.
7756 @end defmac
7757
7758 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7759 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7760 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7761 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7762 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7763 representing the function.
7764
7765 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7766
7767 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7768 of this macro.
7769 @end defmac
7770
7771 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7772 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7773 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7774 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7775 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7776 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7777
7778 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7779 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7780
7781 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7782 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7783 @end defmac
7784
7785 @hook TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME
7786 A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7787 for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7788 target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7789 @code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7790 and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7791 will be an internal label.
7792
7793 The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7794 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7795
7796 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7797 @end deftypefn
7798
7799 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7800 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7801 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7802 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7803
7804 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7805 nothing.
7806 @end defmac
7807
7808 @defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7809 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7810 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7811 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7812 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7813 something about the size of the object.
7814
7815 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7816 nothing.
7817
7818 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7819 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7820 @end defmac
7821
7822 @hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL
7823 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7824 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7825 that is, available for reference from other files.
7826
7827 The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7828 @code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7829 @end deftypefn
7830
7831 @hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME
7832 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7833 @var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7834 global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7835
7836 The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7837 @end deftypefn
7838
7839 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7840 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7841 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7842 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7843 no other definition is available. Use the expression
7844 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7845 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7846 for making that name weak, and a newline.
7847
7848 If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7849 support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7850 macro.
7851 @end defmac
7852
7853 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7854 Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7855 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7856 or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7857 should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7858 defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7859 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7860 to make @var{name} weak.
7861 @end defmac
7862
7863 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7864 Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7865 symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
7866 declaration of @code{name}.
7867 @end defmac
7868
7869 @defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
7870 A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
7871 supports weak symbols.
7872
7873 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7874 definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
7875 is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
7876 @end defmac
7877
7878 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
7879 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
7880
7881 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7882 definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
7883 this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
7884 flag such as @option{-melf}.
7885 @end defmac
7886
7887 @defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
7888 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
7889 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
7890 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
7891 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
7892 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
7893 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
7894 @end defmac
7895
7896 @defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
7897 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
7898 semantics.
7899
7900 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
7901 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
7902 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
7903 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
7904 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
7905 be emitted as one-only.
7906 @end defmac
7907
7908 @hook TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY
7909 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
7910 commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
7911 hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
7912 @end deftypefn
7913
7914 @defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
7915 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
7916 that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
7917 The default is @code{0}.
7918
7919 Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
7920 if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
7921 will have undefined references from other translation units, that
7922 symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
7923 thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
7924 (explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
7925 with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
7926
7927 The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
7928 targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
7929 restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
7930 table of contents.
7931 @end defmac
7932
7933 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
7934 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7935 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
7936 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
7937 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
7938 declaration.
7939
7940 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
7941 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
7942 @end defmac
7943
7944 @hook TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
7945 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7946 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
7947 library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
7948 @end deftypefn
7949
7950 @hook TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED
7951 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7952 directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
7953 .no_dead_code_strip directive.
7954 @end deftypefn
7955
7956 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7957 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7958 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
7959 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
7960 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
7961 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
7962 @end defmac
7963
7964 @hook TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME
7965
7966 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
7967 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
7968 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
7969 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
7970 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
7971 encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
7972 @end defmac
7973
7974 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
7975 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
7976 result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
7977 @code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
7978 This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
7979 specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
7980 when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
7981 being taken.
7982 @end defmac
7983
7984 @hook TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL
7985 A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
7986 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
7987
7988 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
7989 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
7990 will have name conflicts with internal labels.
7991
7992 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
7993 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
7994 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
7995 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
7996 convention your system uses, and follow it.
7997
7998 The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
7999 @end deftypefn
8000
8001 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8002 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8003 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8004 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8005 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8006 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8007 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8008 bundles.
8009
8010 If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8011 used.
8012 @end defmac
8013
8014 @defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8015 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8016 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8017
8018 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8019 produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8020 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8021
8022 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8023 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8024 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8025 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8026 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8027 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8028 you should know what it does on your machine.)
8029 @end defmac
8030
8031 @defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8032 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8033 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8034 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8035 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8036
8037 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8038 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8039 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8040 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8041 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8042 internal static variables in different scopes.
8043
8044 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8045 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8046 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8047 between the name and the number will suffice.
8048
8049 If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8050 which is correct for most systems.
8051 @end defmac
8052
8053 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8054 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8055 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8056
8057 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8058 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8059 correct for most systems.
8060 @end defmac
8061
8062 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8063 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8064 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8065 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8066 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8067 the tree nodes are available.
8068
8069 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8070 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8071 correct for most systems.
8072 @end defmac
8073
8074 @defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8075 A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8076 (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8077 of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8078 current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8079 This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8080 @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8081 @end defmac
8082
8083 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8084 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8085 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8086 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8087 an undefined weak symbol.
8088
8089 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8090 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8091 @end defmac
8092
8093 @defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8094 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8095 Objective-C methods.
8096
8097 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8098 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8099 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8100 @samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8101
8102 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8103 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8104 systems define other ways of computing names.
8105
8106 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8107 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8108 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
8109 50 characters extra.
8110
8111 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8112 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8113 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8114 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8115
8116 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8117 macro to provide more human-readable names.
8118 @end defmac
8119
8120 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8121 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8122 @var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8123 Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets whose
8124 linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8125 @end defmac
8126
8127 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8128 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8129 @var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8130 unresolved Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets
8131 whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8132 @end defmac
8133
8134 @node Initialization
8135 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8136 @cindex initialization routines
8137 @cindex termination routines
8138 @cindex constructors, output of
8139 @cindex destructors, output of
8140
8141 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8142 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8143 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8144 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8145 @code{main} is called.
8146
8147 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8148 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8149 terminates.
8150
8151 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8152 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8153 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8154 system, you need to specify how to do this.
8155
8156 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8157 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8158 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8159
8160 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
8161 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
8162 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8163 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8164 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8165
8166 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
8167 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8168 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8169 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8170 pointer containing zero.
8171
8172 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8173 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8174 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8175 list; destructors in forward order.
8176
8177 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8178 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8179 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8180 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8181 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8182 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8183 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8184 Termination functions are handled similarly.
8185
8186 This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8187 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8188 support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8189 constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8190 and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8191
8192 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8193 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8194 support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8195 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8196 program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8197
8198 @smallexample
8199 ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8200 @end smallexample
8201
8202 The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8203 section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8204 for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8205 files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8206 are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8207
8208 The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8209 compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8210 fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8211 to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8212 of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8213 that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8214
8215 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8216 macro properly.
8217
8218 If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8219 @code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8220 entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8221 it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8222 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8223 in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8224
8225 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8226 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8227 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8228 @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8229 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8230 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8231 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8232 the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8233 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8234 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8235 @code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8236 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8237 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8238 the initialization process.
8239
8240 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8241 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8242 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8243 this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8244 termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8245 an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8246 pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8247 the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8248 initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8249 via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8250 @code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8251
8252 @ifinfo
8253 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8254 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8255 @end ifinfo
8256
8257 @node Macros for Initialization
8258 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8259
8260 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8261 and termination functions:
8262
8263 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8264 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8265 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8266 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8267 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8268 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8269 run the initialization functions.
8270 @end defmac
8271
8272 @defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8273 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8274 This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8275 on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8276 be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8277 @end defmac
8278
8279 @defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8280 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8281 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8282 @end defmac
8283
8284 @defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8285 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8286 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8287 @end defmac
8288
8289 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8290 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8291 automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8292 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8293 the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8294 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8295
8296 This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8297 shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8298 exception tables embedded in the code.
8299 @end defmac
8300
8301 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8302 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8303 automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8304 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8305 the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8306 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8307 @end defmac
8308
8309 @defmac INVOKE__main
8310 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8311 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8312 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8313 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8314 @end defmac
8315
8316 @defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8317 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8318 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8319 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8320 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8321 @end defmac
8322
8323 @hook TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8324 This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8325 collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8326 It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8327 @end deftypevr
8328
8329 @hook TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR
8330 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8331 the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8332
8333 Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8334 no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8335 priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8336 otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8337
8338 If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8339 be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8340 target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8341 is not defined.
8342 @end deftypefn
8343
8344 @hook TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR
8345 This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8346 functions rather than initialization functions.
8347 @end deftypefn
8348
8349 If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8350 generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8351
8352 If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8353 constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8354 an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8355
8356 On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8357 @command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8358
8359 @defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8360 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8361 object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8362 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8363
8364 This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8365 part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8366 @end defmac
8367
8368 @defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8369 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8370 to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8371 @command{nm}.
8372 @end defmac
8373
8374 @defmac NM_FLAGS
8375 @command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8376 constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8377 passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
8378 are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
8379 produces.
8380 @end defmac
8381
8382 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8383 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8384 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8385 termination functions in shared libraries:
8386
8387 @defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8388 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
8389 which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
8390 @end defmac
8391
8392 @defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8393 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8394 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8395 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8396 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8397 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8398 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8399 @end defmac
8400
8401 @defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8402 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8403 library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8404 strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8405 constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8406 that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8407 @end defmac
8408
8409 @node Instruction Output
8410 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8411
8412 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8413 This describes assembler instruction output.
8414
8415 @defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8416 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8417 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8418 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8419 @end defmac
8420
8421 @defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8422 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8423 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8424 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8425 to registers using alternate names.
8426 @end defmac
8427
8428 @defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8429 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8430 name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8431 machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8432 names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8433 declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8434 @code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8435 register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8436
8437 This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8438 @code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8439 register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8440 VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8441 ``s0'' and ``s1''.
8442 @end defmac
8443
8444 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8445 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8446 requires different names for the machine instructions.
8447
8448 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8449 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8450 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8451 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8452 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8453 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8454 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8455 so that it will not be output twice.
8456
8457 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8458 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8459 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8460 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8461 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8462
8463 @findex recog_data.operand
8464 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8465 elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8466
8467 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8468 in the usual way.
8469 @end defmac
8470
8471 @defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8472 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8473 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8474 they will be output differently.
8475
8476 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8477 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8478 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8479 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8480 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8481 by changing the contents of the vector.
8482
8483 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8484 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8485 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8486 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8487 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8488 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8489
8490 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8491 @end defmac
8492
8493 @hook TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN
8494 If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8495 output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8496 if necessary.
8497
8498 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8499 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8500 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8501 The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8502 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8503 by checking the contents of the vector.
8504 @end deftypefn
8505
8506 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8507 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8508 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8509 RTL expression.
8510
8511 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8512 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8513 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8514 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8515 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8516 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8517 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8518
8519 @findex reg_names
8520 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8521 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8522 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8523 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8524
8525 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8526 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8527 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8528 @var{code}.
8529 @end defmac
8530
8531 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8532 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8533 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8534 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8535 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8536 in this way.
8537 @end defmac
8538
8539 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8540 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8541 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8542 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8543
8544 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8545 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8546 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8547 @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8548 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8549 Format}.
8550 @end defmac
8551
8552 @findex dbr_sequence_length
8553 @defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8554 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8555 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8556 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8557 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8558 or whatever.
8559
8560 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8561 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8562 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8563 @end defmac
8564
8565 @findex final_sequence
8566 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8567 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8568 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8569 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8570 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8571 being output.
8572
8573 @findex asm_fprintf
8574 @defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8575 @defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8576 @defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8577 @defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8578 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8579 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8580 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8581 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8582 files can define these macros differently.
8583 @end defmac
8584
8585 @defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8586 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8587 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8588 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8589 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8590 statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8591 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8592 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8593 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8594 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8595 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8596 @end defmac
8597
8598 @defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8599 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8600 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8601 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8602 first variant.
8603
8604 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8605 @smallexample
8606 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8607 @end smallexample
8608 @noindent
8609 in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8610 first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8611 @samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8612 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8613 within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8614 alternatives within the braces than the value of
8615 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
8616
8617 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8618 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8619 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8620
8621 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8622 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8623 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8624 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8625 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8626 opcodes or operand order.
8627 @end defmac
8628
8629 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8630 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8631 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8632 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8633 profiling.
8634 @end defmac
8635
8636 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8637 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8638 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8639 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8640 profiling.
8641 @end defmac
8642
8643 @node Dispatch Tables
8644 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8645
8646 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8647 This concerns dispatch tables.
8648
8649 @cindex dispatch table
8650 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8651 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8652 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8653 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8654 definitions of these labels are output using
8655 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8656 way here. For example,
8657
8658 @smallexample
8659 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8660 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8661 @end smallexample
8662
8663 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8664 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8665 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8666 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8667 mode and flags can be read.
8668 @end defmac
8669
8670 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8671 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8672 in a dispatch table are absolute.
8673
8674 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8675 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8676 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8677 definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8678 For example,
8679
8680 @smallexample
8681 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8682 @end smallexample
8683 @end defmac
8684
8685 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8686 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8687 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8688 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8689 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8690 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8691
8692 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8693 for the table.
8694
8695 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8696 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8697 @end defmac
8698
8699 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8700 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8701 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8702 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8703 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8704 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8705 of the preceding label.
8706
8707 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8708 the jump-table.
8709 @end defmac
8710
8711 @hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL
8712 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8713 should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8714 should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8715 function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8716 The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8717 exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8718 true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8719
8720 The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8721 @end deftypefn
8722
8723 @hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL
8724 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8725 It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8726 to be broken up according to function.
8727
8728 The default is that no label is emitted.
8729 @end deftypefn
8730
8731 @hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY
8732
8733 @hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT
8734 This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
8735 given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8736 returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
8737 @end deftypefn
8738
8739 @hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8740
8741 @node Exception Region Output
8742 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8743
8744 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8745
8746 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8747 region.
8748
8749 @defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8750 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8751 exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8752 provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8753 @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8754
8755 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8756 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8757 @end defmac
8758
8759 @defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8760 If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8761 data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8762 might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8763 collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8764
8765 Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8766 also defined.
8767 @end defmac
8768
8769 @defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8770 Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8771 information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8772 runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8773 and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8774 @end defmac
8775
8776 @defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8777 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8778 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8779 @end defmac
8780
8781 @defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8782 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8783 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8784 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
8785 @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @code{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
8786 or @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8787 @end defmac
8788
8789 @hook TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO
8790 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8791 by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8792 should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8793 @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8794 should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8795 information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
8796
8797 A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8798 This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8799 default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
8800
8801 Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
8802 not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
8803 @var{opts}. In particular, the
8804 setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8805 macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8806 depending on this setting.
8807
8808 The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8809 @option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
8810 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
8811 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
8812 must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
8813 @end deftypefn
8814
8815 @hook TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8816 This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
8817 tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
8818 command-line option processing.
8819 @end deftypevr
8820
8821 @defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8822 Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8823 should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8824 instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8825 @end defmac
8826
8827 @defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8828 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8829 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8830 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8831 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8832 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8833 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8834 @end defmac
8835
8836 @hook TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8837 Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8838 end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8839 Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8840 true otherwise.
8841 @end deftypevr
8842
8843 @hook TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN
8844 Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8845 represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
8846 register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8847 locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8848 register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8849 If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8850 @end deftypefn
8851
8852 @hook TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA
8853 If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8854 multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8855 sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8856 It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8857 filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8858 @var{address} is the address of the table.
8859 @end deftypefn
8860
8861 @hook TARGET_ASM_TTYPE
8862 This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8863 the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
8864 if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
8865 reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8866 @end deftypefn
8867
8868 @hook TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
8869 This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
8870 based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
8871 the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
8872 running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
8873 @end deftypevr
8874
8875 @node Alignment Output
8876 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
8877
8878 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8879 This describes commands for alignment.
8880
8881 @defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8882 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
8883 a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
8884
8885 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8886 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8887 define the macro.
8888
8889 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8890 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
8891 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8892 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
8893 @end defmac
8894
8895 @hook TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8896 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
8897 @code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
8898 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8899 @end deftypefn
8900
8901 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
8902 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8903 a @code{BARRIER}.
8904
8905 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8906 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8907 define the macro.
8908 @end defmac
8909
8910 @hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
8911 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
8912 @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
8913 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8914 @end deftypefn
8915
8916 @defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8917 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8918 a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
8919
8920 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8921 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8922 define the macro.
8923
8924 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8925 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
8926 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8927 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
8928 @end defmac
8929
8930 @hook TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8931 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
8932 @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
8933 defined.
8934 @end deftypefn
8935
8936 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
8937 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
8938 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
8939 the maximum of the specified values is used.
8940
8941 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8942 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
8943 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8944 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
8945 @end defmac
8946
8947 @hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8948 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
8949 to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
8950 is defined.
8951 @end deftypefn
8952
8953 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
8954 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8955 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
8956 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
8957 expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
8958 @end defmac
8959
8960 @defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
8961 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
8962 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
8963 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
8964 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
8965 section.
8966 @end defmac
8967
8968 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8969 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8970 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8971 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
8972 @end defmac
8973
8974 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8975 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
8976 for padding, if necessary.
8977 @end defmac
8978
8979 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
8980 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8981 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8982 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
8983 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
8984 a C expression of type @code{int}.
8985 @end defmac
8986
8987 @need 3000
8988 @node Debugging Info
8989 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
8990
8991 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8992 This describes how to specify debugging information.
8993
8994 @menu
8995 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
8996 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
8997 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
8998 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
8999 * SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9000 * VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9001 @end menu
9002
9003 @node All Debuggers
9004 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9005
9006 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9007 These macros affect all debugging formats.
9008
9009 @defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9010 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9011 register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9012 of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9013 some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9014 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9015 compiler and another for DBX@.
9016
9017 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9018 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9019 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9020 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9021 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9022
9023 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9024 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9025 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9026 @end defmac
9027
9028 @defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9029 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9030 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9031 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9032 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9033 that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9034 for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9035 @option{-g} options is used.
9036 @end defmac
9037
9038 @defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9039 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9040 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9041 @var{offset}.
9042 @end defmac
9043
9044 @defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9045 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9046 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9047 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9048 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9049 @code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9050 @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9051
9052 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9053 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9054 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9055 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9056 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9057
9058 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9059 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9060 @option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9061 @end defmac
9062
9063 @node DBX Options
9064 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9065
9066 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9067 These are specific options for DBX output.
9068
9069 @defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9070 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9071 in response to the @option{-g} option.
9072 @end defmac
9073
9074 @defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9075 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9076 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9077 @end defmac
9078
9079 @defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9080 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9081 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9082 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9083 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9084 if there is any occasion to.
9085 @end defmac
9086
9087 @defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9088 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9089 in the text section.
9090 @end defmac
9091
9092 @defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9093 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9094 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9095 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9096 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9097 @end defmac
9098
9099 @defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9100 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9101 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9102 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9103 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9104 information format.
9105 @end defmac
9106
9107 @defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9108 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9109 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9110 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9111 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9112 @end defmac
9113
9114 @defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9115 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9116 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9117 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9118 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9119 @end defmac
9120
9121 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9122 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9123 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9124 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9125 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9126 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9127 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9128 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9129 @end defmac
9130
9131 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9132 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9133 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9134 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9135 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9136 if backslash is correct for your system.
9137 @end defmac
9138
9139 @defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9140 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9141 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9142 variable.
9143 @end defmac
9144
9145 @defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9146 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9147 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9148 @end defmac
9149
9150 @defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9151 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9152 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9153 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9154 @end defmac
9155
9156 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9157 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9158 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9159 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9160 @end defmac
9161
9162 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9163 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9164 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9165 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9166 @end defmac
9167
9168 @defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9169 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9170 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9171 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9172 code.
9173 @end defmac
9174
9175 @defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9176 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9177 the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9178 relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9179 an absolute address.
9180 @end defmac
9181
9182 @defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9183 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9184 the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9185 start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9186 @end defmac
9187
9188 @defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9189 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9190 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9191 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9192 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9193 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9194 number for a type number.
9195 @end defmac
9196
9197 @node DBX Hooks
9198 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9199
9200 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9201 These are hooks for DBX format.
9202
9203 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9204 Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
9205 information for the start of a scope level for variable names. The
9206 argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
9207 @code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
9208 @end defmac
9209
9210 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9211 Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
9212 @end defmac
9213
9214 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
9215 Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
9216 output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
9217 @end defmac
9218
9219 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9220 A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9221 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9222 @var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9223 invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9224 unique labels in the assembly output.
9225
9226 This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9227 if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9228 @end defmac
9229
9230 @defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9231 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9232 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9233 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9234 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9235 @end defmac
9236
9237 @defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9238 Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9239 extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9240 feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9241 @end defmac
9242
9243 @node File Names and DBX
9244 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
9245
9246 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9247 This describes file names in DBX format.
9248
9249 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9250 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9251 @var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9252 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9253 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9254
9255 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9256 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9257
9258 It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9259 text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9260 to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9261 @var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9262 @end defmac
9263
9264 @defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9265 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9266 of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9267 the beginning of the file.
9268 @end defmac
9269
9270 @defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9271 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9272 that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9273 an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9274 @samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9275 @end defmac
9276
9277 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9278 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9279 compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9280 written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9281
9282 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9283 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9284 @end defmac
9285
9286 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9287 Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9288 @code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9289 the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9290 whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9291 @end defmac
9292
9293 @need 2000
9294 @node SDB and DWARF
9295 @subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9296
9297 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9298 Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9299
9300 @defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9301 Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9302 for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9303 @end defmac
9304
9305 @defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9306 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9307 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9308
9309 @hook TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION
9310 Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9311 be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9312 value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9313 @end deftypefn
9314
9315 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9316 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9317 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9318 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9319 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9320 @end defmac
9321
9322 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9323 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
9324 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9325 (@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9326 exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9327 how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
9328 @end defmac
9329
9330 @hook TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO
9331 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9332 unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9333 @code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9334 return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9335
9336 A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9337 is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9338
9339 A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9340 This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9341 @end deftypefn
9342
9343 @defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9344 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9345 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9346 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9347 @end defmac
9348
9349 @hook TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9350
9351 @hook TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
9352
9353 @hook TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
9354
9355 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9356 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9357 @var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9358 @end defmac
9359
9360 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9361 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9362 between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9363 slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9364 @end defmac
9365
9366 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9367 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9368 section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9369 given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9370 @end defmac
9371
9372 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9373 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9374 reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9375 @end defmac
9376
9377 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9378 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9379 the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9380 is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9381 is referenced by a function.
9382 @end defmac
9383
9384 @hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
9385 If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9386 reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9387 @end deftypefn
9388
9389 @defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9390 Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9391 SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9392 macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9393 not define them yourself.
9394 @end defmac
9395
9396 @defmac SDB_DELIM
9397 Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9398 SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9399 delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9400 a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9401 required.
9402 @end defmac
9403
9404 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9405 Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9406 union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9407 allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9408 it.
9409 @end defmac
9410
9411 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9412 Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9413 enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9414 assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9415 @end defmac
9416
9417 @defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9418 A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9419 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9420 @var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9421 @end defmac
9422
9423 @need 2000
9424 @node VMS Debug
9425 @subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9426
9427 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9428 Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9429
9430 @defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9431 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9432 in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9433 is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9434 @option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
9435 behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
9436 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9437 @end defmac
9438
9439 @node Floating Point
9440 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9441 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
9442 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
9443
9444 While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9445 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9446 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9447 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9448 doing the compilation.
9449
9450 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9451 range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9452 the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9453 safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9454 the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9455 emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9456 target floating point formats are identical.
9457
9458 The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9459 use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9460 floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9461 their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9462
9463 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9464 The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9465 machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9466 array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9467 quantity.
9468 @end defmac
9469
9470 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9471 Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9472 floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9473 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9474 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9475 @end deftypefn
9476
9477 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9478 Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9479 @end deftypefn
9480
9481 @deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9482 Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9483 @end deftypefn
9484
9485 @deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9486 Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9487 @var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9488 @end deftypefn
9489
9490 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9491 Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9492 representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9493 decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9494 defined by the C language for both.
9495 @end deftypefn
9496
9497 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9498 Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9499 @end deftypefn
9500
9501 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9502 Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9503 @end deftypefn
9504
9505 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9506 Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9507 @end deftypefn
9508
9509 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9510 Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9511 @var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9512 variable).
9513
9514 The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9515 following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9516 @code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9517
9518 If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9519 target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9520 @code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9521 @code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9522 @end deftypefn
9523
9524 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9525 Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9526 @end deftypefn
9527
9528 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9529 Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9530 @end deftypefn
9531
9532 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{x})
9533 Truncates the floating point value @var{x} to fit in @var{mode}. The
9534 return value is still a full-size @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, but it has an
9535 appropriate bit pattern to be output as a floating constant whose
9536 precision accords with mode @var{mode}.
9537 @end deftypefn
9538
9539 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9540 Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9541 which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9542 integral, it is truncated.
9543 @end deftypefn
9544
9545 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9546 Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9547 into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9548 value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9549 @end deftypefn
9550
9551 @node Mode Switching
9552 @section Mode Switching Instructions
9553 @cindex mode switching
9554 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9555
9556 @defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9557 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9558 switching in an optimizing compilation.
9559
9560 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9561 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9562 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9563 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9564 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9565 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9566 or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9567
9568 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9569 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9570 return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9571 If you define this macro, you also have to define
9572 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9573 @code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9574 @code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9575 are optional.
9576 @end defmac
9577
9578 @defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9579 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9580 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9581 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9582 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9583 The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9584 zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9585 entity in question.
9586 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9587 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9588 switch is needed / supplied.
9589 @end defmac
9590
9591 @defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9592 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9593 @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9594 return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9595 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9596 be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9597 @end defmac
9598
9599 @defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{mode}, @var{insn})
9600 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
9601 mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9602 different from the incoming mode).
9603 @end defmac
9604
9605 @defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9606 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9607 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9608 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9609 is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9610 @end defmac
9611
9612 @defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9613 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9614 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9615 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9616 is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9617 @end defmac
9618
9619 @defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9620 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
9621 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9622 lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9623 for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9624 (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9625 @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9626 @end defmac
9627
9628 @defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9629 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9630 @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9631 the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9632 @end defmac
9633
9634 @node Target Attributes
9635 @section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9636 @cindex target attributes
9637 @cindex machine attributes
9638 @cindex attributes, target-specific
9639
9640 Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9641 These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9642 be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9643
9644 @hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9645 If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9646 attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9647 specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9648 entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9649 take.
9650 @end deftypevr
9651
9652 @hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P
9653 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9654 machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9655 given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9656 subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9657 false for all machine-specific attributes.
9658 @end deftypefn
9659
9660 @hook TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9661 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9662 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9663 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9664 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9665 supposed always to be compatible.
9666 @end deftypefn
9667
9668 @hook TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9669 If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9670 the newly defined @var{type}.
9671 @end deftypefn
9672
9673 @hook TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9674 Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9675 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9676 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9677 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9678 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9679 merging.
9680 @end deftypefn
9681
9682 @hook TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9683 Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9684 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9685 @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9686 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9687 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9688 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9689 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9690
9691 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9692 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9693 for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9694 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9695 will then define a function called
9696 @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9697 the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9698 add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9699 to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9700 @samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9701 @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9702 @end deftypefn
9703
9704 @hook TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P
9705
9706 @defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9707 Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9708 @code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9709 default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9710 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9711 of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9712 on this implementation detail.
9713 @end defmac
9714
9715 @hook TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES
9716 Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9717 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9718 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9719 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9720 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9721 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9722 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9723 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9724 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9725 needed.
9726 @end deftypefn
9727
9728 @hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P
9729 @cindex inlining
9730 This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9731 into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9732 attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9733 target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9734 @end deftypefn
9735
9736 @hook TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P
9737 This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9738 it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9739 options for the current function that might be different than the
9740 options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9741 @code{true} if the options are valid.
9742
9743 The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9744 the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9745 @var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9746 @end deftypefn
9747
9748 @hook TARGET_OPTION_SAVE
9749 This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9750 in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9751 options.
9752 @xref{Option file format}.
9753 @end deftypefn
9754
9755 @hook TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE
9756 This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9757 information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9758 function specific options.
9759 @end deftypefn
9760
9761 @hook TARGET_OPTION_PRINT
9762 This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9763 information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9764 function specific options.
9765 @end deftypefn
9766
9767 @hook TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE
9768 This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9769 set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9770 input stream. The options should be the same as handled by the
9771 @code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
9772 @end deftypefn
9773
9774 @hook TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE
9775 Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9776 a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9777 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9778 once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9779
9780 Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
9781 @option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
9782
9783 If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9784 changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9785 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9786 @end deftypefn
9787
9788 @hook TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P
9789 This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9790 cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9791 default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9792 specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9793 @end deftypefn
9794
9795 @node Emulated TLS
9796 @section Emulating TLS
9797 @cindex Emulated TLS
9798
9799 For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9800 specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9801 used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9802 configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
9803 the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9804 layer.
9805
9806 The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9807 object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9808 which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9809 address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9810
9811 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9812 Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9813 object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9814 emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9815 @end deftypevr
9816
9817 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9818 Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9819 program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9820 initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9821 have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9822 registration function to be used.
9823 @end deftypevr
9824
9825 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9826 Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9827 be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9828 any section.
9829 @end deftypevr
9830
9831 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9832 Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9833 placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9834 section.
9835 @end deftypevr
9836
9837 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9838 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9839 The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9840 @end deftypevr
9841
9842 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9843 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9844 default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9845 @end deftypevr
9846
9847 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS
9848 Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9849 object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9850 @var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9851 @code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9852 for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9853 @end deftypefn
9854
9855 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT
9856 Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9857 TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9858 is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9859 initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
9860 @end deftypefn
9861
9862 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
9863 Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
9864 fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
9865 single objects. The default is false.
9866 @end deftypevr
9867
9868 @hook TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
9869 Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
9870 may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
9871 @end deftypevr
9872
9873 @node MIPS Coprocessors
9874 @section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
9875 @cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
9876
9877 The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
9878 coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
9879 accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
9880 and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
9881
9882 @smallexample
9883 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
9884 unsigned int d;
9885
9886 d = cp0count + 3;
9887 @end smallexample
9888
9889 (``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
9890 names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
9891 overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
9892
9893 Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
9894 be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
9895 later in the function.
9896
9897 Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
9898 the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
9899 floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
9900
9901 There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
9902 you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
9903
9904 @defmac ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
9905 A comma-separated list (with leading comma) of pairs describing the
9906 alternate names of coprocessor registers. The format of each entry should be
9907 @smallexample
9908 @{ @var{alternatename}, @var{register_number}@}
9909 @end smallexample
9910 Default: empty.
9911 @end defmac
9912
9913 @node PCH Target
9914 @section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
9915 @cindex parameters, precompiled headers
9916
9917 @hook TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY
9918 This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
9919 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
9920 @samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
9921 @end deftypefn
9922
9923 @hook TARGET_PCH_VALID_P
9924 This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
9925 compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
9926 if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
9927 be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
9928
9929 @var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
9930 when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
9931 It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
9932 compiler, so no format checking is needed.
9933
9934 The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
9935 suitable for most targets.
9936 @end deftypefn
9937
9938 @hook TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS
9939 If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
9940 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
9941 of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
9942 @code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
9943 value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
9944 @end deftypefn
9945
9946 @node C++ ABI
9947 @section C++ ABI parameters
9948 @cindex parameters, c++ abi
9949
9950 @hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE
9951 Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
9952 These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
9953 default is long_long_integer_type_node.
9954 @end deftypefn
9955
9956 @hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT
9957 This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
9958 @code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
9959 @code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
9960 @end deftypefn
9961
9962 @hook TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE
9963 This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
9964 whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
9965 known that a cookie is needed. The default is
9966 @code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
9967 IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
9968 @end deftypefn
9969
9970 @hook TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE
9971 This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
9972 array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
9973 @end deftypefn
9974
9975 @hook TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS
9976 If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
9977 class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
9978 will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
9979 to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
9980 modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
9981 backend's targeted operating system.
9982 @end deftypefn
9983
9984 @hook TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS
9985 This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
9986 the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
9987 @code{false}.
9988 @end deftypefn
9989
9990 @hook TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE
9991 This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
9992 which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
9993 table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
9994 Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
9995 the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
9996 some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
9997 method. The default is to return @code{true}.
9998 @end deftypefn
9999
10000 @hook TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY
10001
10002 @hook TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT
10003 This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10004 similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10005 external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10006 classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10007 unit will not be COMDAT.
10008 @end deftypefn
10009
10010 @hook TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT
10011 This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10012 the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10013 be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10014 @end deftypefn
10015
10016 @hook TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT
10017 This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10018 should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10019 is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10020 @end deftypefn
10021
10022 @hook TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT
10023 This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10024 in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10025 destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10026 shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10027 unloaded. The default is to return false.
10028 @end deftypefn
10029
10030 @hook TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION
10031
10032 @node Named Address Spaces
10033 @section Adding support for named address spaces
10034 @cindex named address spaces
10035
10036 The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10037 standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10038 support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10039 processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10040 GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10041 address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10042 spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10043 @code{const} type attributes.
10044
10045 Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10046 pointers to the generic address space.
10047
10048 For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10049 to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10050 processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10051 issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10052 local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10053 address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10054 @option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10055 always 32 bits).
10056
10057 Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10058 range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10059 address space.
10060
10061 To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10062 the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10063 the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10064 named address space #1:
10065 @smallexample
10066 #define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10067 c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10068 @end smallexample
10069
10070 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE
10071 Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10072 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10073 The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10074 generic address space only.
10075 @end deftypefn
10076
10077 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE
10078 Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10079 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10080 The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10081 generic address space only.
10082 @end deftypefn
10083
10084 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE
10085 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10086 with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10087 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10088 except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10089 version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10090 @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10091 target hooks for the given address space.
10092 @end deftypefn
10093
10094 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
10095 Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10096 @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10097 parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10098 finished. This target hook is the same as the
10099 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10100 explicit named address space support.
10101 @end deftypefn
10102
10103 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
10104 Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10105 with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10106 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10107 except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10108 @end deftypefn
10109
10110 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P
10111 Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10112 contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10113 a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10114 will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10115 arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10116 converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10117 @end deftypefn
10118
10119 @hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT
10120 Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10121 @var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10122 space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10123 to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10124 guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10125 as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10126 @end deftypefn
10127
10128 @node Misc
10129 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
10130 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10131
10132 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10133 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10134
10135 @defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10136 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10137 has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10138 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10139 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10140 set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10141 to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10142 @end defmac
10143
10144 @defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10145 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10146 has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10147 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10148 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10149 set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10150 to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10151 @end defmac
10152
10153 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10154 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10155 elements of a jump-table should have.
10156 @end defmac
10157
10158 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10159 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10160 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10161 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10162 To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10163 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10164 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10165 flags can be updated.
10166 @end defmac
10167
10168 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10169 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10170 should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10171 jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10172 contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10173 is in effect.
10174 @end defmac
10175
10176 @hook TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
10177 This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10178 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10179 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10180 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10181 @end deftypefn
10182
10183 @defmac CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
10184 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate whether C switch
10185 statements may be implemented by a sequence of bit tests. This is
10186 advantageous on processors that can efficiently implement left shift
10187 of 1 by the number of bits held in a register, but inappropriate on
10188 targets that would require a loop. By default, this macro returns
10189 @code{true} if the target defines an @code{ashlsi3} pattern, and
10190 @code{false} otherwise.
10191 @end defmac
10192
10193 @defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10194 Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10195 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10196 Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10197 @end defmac
10198
10199 @defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10200 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10201 memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10202 bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10203 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10204 of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10205 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10206 @code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10207
10208 This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10209 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10210 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10211 @code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10212 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10213
10214 You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10215 the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10216 of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10217 when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10218 integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10219
10220 You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10221 mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10222 @code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10223 is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10224 @end defmac
10225
10226 @defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10227 Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10228 extends.
10229 @end defmac
10230
10231 @defmac FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
10232 Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
10233 point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
10234 unsigned one.
10235 @end defmac
10236
10237 @hook TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL
10238 When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10239 divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10240 the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10241 that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10242 of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10243 has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10244 @end deftypefn
10245
10246 @defmac MOVE_MAX
10247 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10248 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10249 @end defmac
10250
10251 @defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10252 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10253 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10254 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10255 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10256 at run-time.
10257 @end defmac
10258
10259 @defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10260 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10261 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10262 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10263 this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10264 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10265 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10266 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10267 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10268 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10269 arguments to bit-field instructions.
10270
10271 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10272 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10273 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10274
10275 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10276 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10277 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10278 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10279 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10280
10281 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10282 @end defmac
10283
10284 @anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10285 @hook TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK
10286 This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10287 deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10288 @xref{shift patterns}.
10289
10290 On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10291 shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10292 equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10293 this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10294 otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10295 particular behavior is guaranteed.
10296
10297 Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10298 @emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10299 that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10300
10301 The default implementation of this function returns
10302 @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10303 and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10304 @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10305 nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10306 by overriding it.
10307 @end deftypefn
10308
10309 @defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10310 A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10311 ``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10312 bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10313 operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10314
10315 On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10316
10317 @c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10318 @c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10319 When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10320 modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10321 If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10322 such cases may improve things.
10323 @end defmac
10324
10325 @hook TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED
10326 The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10327 are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10328 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10329 sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10330 otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10331 representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10332 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10333 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10334 @var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10335 widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10336
10337 Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10338 value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10339 as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10340 @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10341
10342 Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10343 describe two related properties. If you define
10344 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10345 to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10346 extension.
10347
10348 In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10349 @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10350 @code{mode}.
10351 @end deftypefn
10352
10353 @defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10354 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10355 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10356 (@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10357 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10358 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10359
10360 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10361 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10362 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10363 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10364 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10365 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10366 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10367 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10368 the compiler.
10369
10370 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10371 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10372 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10373 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10374 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10375 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10376 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10377 expression
10378
10379 @smallexample
10380 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10381 @end smallexample
10382
10383 @noindent
10384 can be converted to
10385
10386 @smallexample
10387 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10388 @end smallexample
10389
10390 @noindent
10391 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10392 tested into the sign bit.
10393
10394 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10395 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10396 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10397 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10398 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10399 comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10400
10401 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10402 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10403 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10404 to be used:
10405
10406 @itemize @bullet
10407 @item
10408 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10409 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10410 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10411 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10412 combine the normalization with other operations.
10413
10414 @item
10415 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10416 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10417 other machines.
10418
10419 @item
10420 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10421 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10422 others.
10423
10424 @item
10425 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10426 @end itemize
10427
10428 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10429 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10430 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10431 those cases, e.g., one matching
10432
10433 @smallexample
10434 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10435 @end smallexample
10436
10437 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10438 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10439 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10440 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10441 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10442 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
10443 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
10444 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10445
10446 If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10447 not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10448 instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10449 @end defmac
10450
10451 @defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10452 A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10453 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10454 Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10455 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10456 this macro.
10457 @end defmac
10458
10459 @defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10460 A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10461 for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10462 mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10463 this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10464 return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10465 this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10466 @code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10467 the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10468 given mode.
10469 @end defmac
10470
10471 @defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10472 @defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10473 A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10474 for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10475 A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10476 If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10477 evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10478 entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10479 the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10480 In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10481 this value.
10482
10483 If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10484 @code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10485
10486 This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10487 relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10488 is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10489 to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10490
10491 Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10492 and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10493 visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10494 to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10495 breaking the API@.
10496 @end defmac
10497
10498 @defmac Pmode
10499 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10500 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10501 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10502 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10503 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10504
10505 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10506 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10507 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10508 to @code{Pmode}.
10509 @end defmac
10510
10511 @defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10512 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10513 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10514 where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10515 @code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10516 size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10517 as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10518 @end defmac
10519
10520 @defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10521 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10522 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10523 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10524 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10525 strict conformance to the C Standard.
10526
10527 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10528 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10529 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10530 @end defmac
10531
10532 @defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10533 Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10534 This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10535 C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10536 @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10537 @end defmac
10538
10539 @findex #pragma
10540 @findex pragma
10541 @defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10542 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10543 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10544 @code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10545 for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10546 setup required for the pragmas.
10547
10548 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10549 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10550 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10551
10552 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10553 defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10554
10555 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10556 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10557 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10558 @end defmac
10559
10560 @deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10561 @deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10562
10563 Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10564 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10565 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10566 pragma of the form
10567
10568 @smallexample
10569 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10570 @end smallexample
10571
10572 @var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10573 @code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10574 routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10575 on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10576 @var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10577 callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10578 a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10579 arguments of pragmas registered with
10580 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10581 pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10582
10583 Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10584 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10585 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10586 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10587 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10588 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10589 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10590 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10591 code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10592 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10593 how to build this object file.
10594 @end deftypefun
10595
10596 @defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
10597 Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
10598 arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10599 @end defmac
10600
10601 @hook TARGET_HANDLE_PRAGMA_EXTERN_PREFIX
10602
10603 @defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10604 If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10605 the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10606 This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10607 @samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10608 @end defmac
10609
10610 @defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10611 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10612 identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10613 not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10614 there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10615 @end defmac
10616
10617 @defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
10618 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10619 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
10620 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
10621 @samp{.} is used instead.
10622 @end defmac
10623
10624 @defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
10625 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10626 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
10627 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
10628 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
10629 @end defmac
10630
10631 @defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10632 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10633 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10634 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10635 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10636 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10637 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10638 you should define this macro.
10639
10640 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10641 @end defmac
10642
10643 @defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10644 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10645 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10646 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10647 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10648 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10649 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10650 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10651 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10652 slot of @var{insn}.
10653
10654 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10655 @end defmac
10656
10657 @defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10658 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10659 global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10660 symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10661 instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10662 from shared libraries (DLLs).
10663
10664 You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10665 @end defmac
10666
10667 @hook TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS
10668 This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10669 any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10670 It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10671 clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10672 corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10673 clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
10674 @code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10675 for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10676 @end deftypefn
10677
10678 @defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10679 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
10680 in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10681 @samp{""} if the target does not have a
10682 separate math library.
10683
10684 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
10685 @end defmac
10686
10687 @defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10688 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10689 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10690
10691 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10692 is wrong.
10693 @end defmac
10694
10695 @defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10696 Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10697 functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10698 Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10699 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10700 if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10701 for cross-profiling.
10702 @end defmac
10703
10704 @defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10705
10706 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10707 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10708 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
10709 1 if it does use cc0.
10710 @end defmac
10711
10712 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10713 Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10714 conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10715 @var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10716 contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10717 and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10718 then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10719 @var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10720 @end defmac
10721
10722 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10723 Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10724 if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10725 @var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10726 being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10727 @end defmac
10728
10729 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10730 A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10731 be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10732 a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10733 about the currently processed blocks.
10734 @end defmac
10735
10736 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10737 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10738 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10739 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10740 to by @var{ce_info}.
10741 @end defmac
10742
10743 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10744 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10745 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10746 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10747 to by @var{ce_info}.
10748 @end defmac
10749
10750 @defmac IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS (@var{ce_info})
10751 A C expression to initialize any extra fields in a @code{struct ce_if_block}
10752 structure, which are defined by the @code{IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10753 @end defmac
10754
10755 @defmac IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
10756 If defined, it should expand to a set of field declarations that will be
10757 added to the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure. These should be initialized
10758 by the @code{IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10759 @end defmac
10760
10761 @hook TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
10762 If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10763 instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10764 just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10765
10766 The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10767 it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10768 laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10769 Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10770
10771 You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10772 definition is null.
10773 @end deftypefn
10774
10775 @hook TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
10776 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10777 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
10778 necessary setup.
10779
10780 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10781 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10782 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10783 instructions or prefetch instructions).
10784
10785 To create a built-in function, call the function
10786 @code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10787 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
10788 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes} and @code{build_common_tree_nodes_2};
10789 only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10790 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10791 @end deftypefn
10792
10793 @hook TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL
10794 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10795 that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10796 builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10797 If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10798 if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10799 If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10800 @code{error_mark_node}.
10801 @end deftypefn
10802
10803 @hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
10804
10805 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10806 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10807 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10808 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10809 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10810 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10811 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10812 built-in function.
10813 @end deftypefn
10814
10815 @hook TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN
10816 Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10817 was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10818 @emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10819 implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10820 declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10821 arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10822 complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10823 another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10824 @var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10825 @end deftypefn
10826
10827 @hook TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN
10828 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10829 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10830 built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10831 the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10832 The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10833 call's result. If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10834 @end deftypefn
10835
10836 @hook TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP
10837
10838 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
10839 low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10840 could not be applied.
10841
10842 Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10843 instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
10844 the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
10845 By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
10846 loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
10847 @end deftypefn
10848
10849 @defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
10850
10851 Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
10852 Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10853 @var{branch2} is possible.
10854
10855 On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
10856 filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10857 may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
10858 @end defmac
10859
10860 @hook TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P
10861 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
10862 Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
10863 PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
10864 of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
10865 @end deftypefn
10866
10867 @hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE
10868
10869 When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
10870 register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
10871 to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
10872 it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
10873 is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
10874 that had its initial value copied by using
10875 @code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
10876 Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
10877 to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
10878 the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
10879 @code{MEM}.
10880 If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
10881 it might decide to use another register anyways.
10882 You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the hook, functions
10883 that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
10884 register in question will not be clobbered.
10885 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
10886 allocation.
10887 @end deftypefn
10888
10889 @hook TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P
10890 This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
10891 @code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
10892 this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
10893 @code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
10894 to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
10895 passed along.
10896 @end deftypefn
10897
10898 @hook TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION
10899 The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
10900 context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
10901 the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
10902 per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
10903 attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
10904 The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
10905 and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
10906 and is returning to processing at the top level.
10907 The default hook function does nothing.
10908
10909 GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
10910 some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
10911 situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
10912 or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
10913 @code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
10914 outside of any function scope.
10915 @end deftypefn
10916
10917 @defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
10918 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
10919 files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
10920 use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
10921 @end defmac
10922
10923 @defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
10924 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
10925 automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
10926 do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
10927 executable files.
10928 @end defmac
10929
10930 @defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
10931 If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
10932 specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
10933 Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
10934 object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
10935 lists.
10936 @end defmac
10937
10938 @defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
10939 Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
10940 method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
10941 must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
10942 For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
10943 the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
10944 defined as this expression:
10945
10946 @smallexample
10947 build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
10948 build_tree_list
10949 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
10950 NULL))
10951 @end smallexample
10952 @end defmac
10953
10954 @hook TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P
10955 This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
10956 instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
10957 every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
10958 reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
10959
10960 @smallexample
10961 static bool
10962 cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
10963 @{
10964 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
10965 @}
10966 @end smallexample
10967 @end deftypefn
10968
10969 @hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS
10970 This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
10971 optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
10972 usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
10973 re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
10974 to inter-block scheduling.
10975 @end deftypefn
10976
10977 @hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED
10978 Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
10979 registers
10980 that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
10981 returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
10982 that all target registers in the class returned by
10983 @samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
10984 saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
10985 epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
10986 true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
10987 to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
10988 to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
10989 @end deftypefn
10990
10991 @hook TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION
10992 This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
10993 This target hook is required only when the target has several different
10994 modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
10995 @end deftypefn
10996
10997 @hook TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST
10998 This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
10999 should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11000 the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11001 the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11002 is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11003 number of memory accesses.
11004 @end deftypefn
11005
11006 @defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11007 If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11008 that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11009 that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11010 constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11011 more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11012 system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11013 The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11014 @end defmac
11015
11016 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11017 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11018 target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11019 are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11020 The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11021 @end deftypefn
11022
11023 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11024 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11025 target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11026 indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11027 @var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11028 @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11029 @end deftypefn
11030
11031 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11032 This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11033 The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11034 systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11035 that are different from @option{-I}.
11036 @end deftypefn
11037
11038 @defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11039 This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11040 for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11041 @code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11042 functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11043 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11044 @end defmac
11045
11046 @defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11047 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11048 target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11049 option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11050 @end defmac
11051
11052 @defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11053 If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11054 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11055 @end defmac
11056
11057 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11058 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11059 target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11060 default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11061 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11062 @end defmac
11063
11064 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11065 If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11066 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11067 @end defmac
11068
11069 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11070 If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11071 routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11072 and scanf formatter settings.
11073 @end defmac
11074
11075 @hook TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11076 If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11077 guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11078 main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11079 important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11080 many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11081 ``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11082 and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
11083 @end deftypevr
11084
11085 @hook TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN
11086 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11087 illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11088 with prototype @var{typelist}.
11089 @end deftypefn
11090
11091 @hook TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION
11092 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11093 invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11094 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11095 @end deftypefn
11096
11097 @hook TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP
11098 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11099 invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11100 @code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11101 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11102 @end deftypefn
11103
11104 @hook TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP
11105 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11106 invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11107 and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11108 the front end.
11109 @end deftypefn
11110
11111 @hook TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE
11112 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11113 invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
11114 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11115 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11116 @end deftypefn
11117
11118 @hook TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE
11119 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11120 invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
11121 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11122 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11123 @end deftypefn
11124
11125 @hook TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE
11126 If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11127 @var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11128 analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11129 front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11130 target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11131 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11132 @end deftypefn
11133
11134 @hook TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE
11135 If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11136 @var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11137 or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11138 This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11139 conversion rules.
11140 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11141 @end deftypefn
11142
11143 @defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11144 This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11145 classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11146 SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11147 @end defmac
11148
11149 @defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11150 This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11151 NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11152 @end defmac
11153
11154 @defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11155 Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11156 to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11157 call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11158 and the associated definitions of those functions.
11159 @end defmac
11160
11161 @hook TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY
11162 Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11163 necessary.
11164 @end deftypefn
11165
11166 @hook TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX
11167 This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11168 different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11169 argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11170 is needed.
11171 @end deftypefn
11172
11173 @hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS
11174 When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11175 arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11176 stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11177 debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11178 @code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11179 cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11180 to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11181 false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11182 @end deftypefn
11183
11184 @hook TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11185 On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11186 a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11187 is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11188 is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11189 subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11190 the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11191 available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11192 constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11193 down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11194 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11195 accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11196 value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11197 MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11198 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11199 is zero, which disables this optimization. @end deftypevr